]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - etc/NEWS
*** empty log message ***
[gnu-emacs] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions.
5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10
11 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
15 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
16
17 \f
18 * Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
19
20 ---
21 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
22 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
23 installed programs.
24
25 ---
26 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
27
28 ---
29 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
30 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
31 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
32
33 ---
34 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with Lisp code.
35
36 ---
37 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
38 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
39 place for game scores to be stored. You can control this with the
40 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
41 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
42 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
43 in each user's home directory.
44
45 ---
46 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
47 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
48 Emacs with Leim.
49
50 +++
51 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
52
53 The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual in Info format is built as part of the
54 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
55 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
56 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
57
58 ---
59 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
60 the distribution.
61
62 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
63 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
64 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
65 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
66
67 ---
68 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the
69 following languages: Brasilian Portuguese, Bulgarian, Chinese (both
70 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian.
71 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup
72 doesn't automatically select the right one.
73
74 ---
75 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
76
77 ---
78 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand.
79 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
80 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
81 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
82
83 ---
84 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
85
86 ---
87 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
88
89 ---
90 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
91
92 ---
93 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
94 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
95
96 ---
97 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
98
99 ---
100 ** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
101 create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
102 the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
103
104 ---
105 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
106 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
107
108 ---
109 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
110 much pure storage it will approximately need.
111
112 ** The script etc/emacs-buffer.gdb can be used with gdb to retrieve the
113 contents of buffers from a core dump and save them to files easily, should
114 emacs crash.
115
116 ---
117 ** The Emacs terminal emulation in term.el uses a different terminfo name.
118 The Emacs terminal emulation in term.el now uses "eterm-color" as its
119 terminfo name, since term.el now supports color.
120
121 ---
122 ** Emacs Lisp source files are compressed by default if `gzip' is available.
123
124 \f
125 * Startup Changes in Emacs 22.1
126
127 +++
128 ** New command line option -Q or --quick.
129 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
130 the fancy startup screen.
131
132 +++
133 ** New command line option -D or --basic-display.
134 Disables the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, and
135 the blinking cursor.
136
137 +++
138 ** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
139 the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
140
141 +++
142 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
143 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
144 can start with this line:
145
146 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
147
148 +++
149 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
150 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
151 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
152
153 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
154
155 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
156 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
157
158 +++
159 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
160 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
161
162 +++
163 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
164 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
165 an interactively callable function.
166
167 +++
168 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
169 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
170 affects the initial frame.
171
172 +++
173 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
174 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
175 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
176 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
177 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
178
179 +++
180 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
181 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
182 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
183 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
184 `inhibit-splash-screen').
185
186 +++
187 ** The default is now to use an bitmap as the icon, so the command-line options
188 --icon-type, -i has been replaced with options --no-bitmap-icon, -nbi to turn
189 the bitmap icon off.
190
191 +++
192 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
193 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
194 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
195
196 +++
197 ** Init file changes
198 If the init file ~/.emacs does not exist, Emacs will try
199 ~/.emacs.d/init.el or ~/.emacs.d/init.elc. You can also put the shell
200 init file .emacs_SHELL under ~/.emacs.d.
201
202 +++
203 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
204 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
205 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
206 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
207 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
208 \f
209 * Incompatible Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
210
211 +++
212 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
213 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
214 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
215 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
216
217 +++
218 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
219 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
220
221 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
222 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
223
224 +++
225 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
226 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
227 the operating system or your X server.
228
229 +++
230 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
231
232 +++
233 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
234 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
235 you about it.
236
237 +++
238 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
239 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
240
241 +++
242 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
243 previous mark if you set `set-mark-command-repeat-pop' to t. I.e. C-u
244 C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC
245 to set the mark immediately after a jump.
246
247 +++
248 ** The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
249 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
250
251 +++
252 ** In incremental search, C-w is changed. M-%, C-M-w and C-M-y are special.
253
254 See below under "incremental search changes".
255
256 ---
257 ** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
258
259 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
260 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
261 directory with Dired.
262
263 You can get the old behavior by typing C-x C-f M-n RET, which fetches
264 the actual file name into the minibuffer.
265
266 +++
267 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
268 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
269 it remains unchanged.
270
271 +++
272 ** When Emacs prompts for file names, SPC no longer completes the file name.
273 This is so filenames with embedded spaces could be input without the
274 need to quote the space with a C-q. The underlying changes in the
275 keymaps that are active in the minibuffer are described below under
276 "New keymaps for typing file names".
277
278 +++
279 ** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
280 M-o M-o requests refontification.
281
282 +++
283 ** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
284
285 See below for more details.
286
287 +++
288 ** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
289 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
290 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
291 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
292 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
293 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
294 \f
295 * Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
296
297 +++
298 ** !MEM FULL! at the start of the mode line indicates that Emacs
299 cannot get any more memory for Lisp data. This often means it could
300 crash soon if you do things that use more memory. On most systems,
301 killing buffers will get out of this state. If killing buffers does
302 not make !MEM FULL! disappear, you should save your work and start
303 a new Emacs.
304
305 +++
306 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
307 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
308
309 +++
310 ** You can now switch buffers in a cyclic order with C-x C-left
311 (previous-buffer) and C-x C-right (next-buffer). C-x left and
312 C-x right can be used as well. The functions keep a different buffer
313 cycle for each frame, using the frame-local buffer list.
314
315 +++
316 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
317
318 +++
319 ** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
320 converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
321
322 ---
323 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
324 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
325
326 +++
327 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
328 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
329
330 +++
331 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
332 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
333 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
334 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
335
336 +++
337 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
338 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
339 in Indented-Text mode.
340
341 +++
342 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variable references.
343
344 Substrings of the form `$foo' and `${foo}' in the specified new value
345 now refer to the value of environment variable foo. To include a `$'
346 in the value, use `$$'.
347
348 +++
349 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
350 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
351 `same-window'.
352
353 +++
354 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
355 from the locale.
356
357 ** The command `list-faces-display' now accepts a prefix arg.
358 When passed, the function prompts for a regular expression and lists
359 only faces matching this regexp.
360
361 ** Mark command changes:
362
363 +++
364 *** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
365 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
366 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
367
368 +++
369 *** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times.
370
371 If you type C-M-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h
372 (mark-paragraph), or C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region
373 extends each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC
374 M-C-SPC, for example. This feature also works for
375 mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to a key. It also extends the
376 region when the mark is active in Transient Mark mode, regardless of
377 the last command. To start a new region with one of marking commands
378 in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the active region with C-g,
379 or set the new mark with C-SPC.
380
381 +++
382 *** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
383
384 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
385 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
386 paragraphs.
387
388 +++
389 *** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
390 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
391 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
392 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
393 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
394 command only.
395
396 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
397 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
398 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
399 mark or the region.
400
401 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
402 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
403 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
404 C-g.
405
406 +++
407 *** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
408 `beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
409 is already active in Transient Mark mode.
410
411 ** Help command changes:
412
413 +++
414 *** Changes in C-h bindings:
415
416 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
417
418 C-h d runs apropos-documentation.
419
420 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
421 that do not change:
422
423 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
424 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
425
426 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
427 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
428
429 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
430 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
431 run by the key sequence.
432 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
433 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
434 that command.
435
436 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
437 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
438 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
439 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
440 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
441 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
442 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
443 new-kill-line is on C-k
444
445 ---
446 *** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
447 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
448 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
449 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
450
451 +++
452 *** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
453 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
454
455 +++
456 *** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
457 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
458 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
459 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
460 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
461 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
462 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node'). In
463 addition, it now makes hyperlinks to URLs as well if the URL is
464 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `URL'.
465
466 +++
467 *** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
468 description various information about a character, including its
469 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
470 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
471 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
472
473 +++
474 *** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
475 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
476
477 +++
478 *** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
479 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
480 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
481 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
482 keyboard oriented alternative.
483
484 +++
485 *** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
486 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
487 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
488 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
489 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
490
491 +++
492 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
493 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
494 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
495 available.
496
497 +++
498 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
499 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
500 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
501 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
502 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
503 matching item.
504
505 ** Incremental Search changes:
506
507 +++
508 *** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
509 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
510 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
511 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
512 for details.
513
514 +++
515 *** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
516 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
517 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
518 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
519
520 +++
521 *** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
522 at the end of a line.
523
524 +++
525 *** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
526 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
527 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
528
529 +++
530 *** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
531 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
532 search string used as the string to replace.
533
534 +++
535 *** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
536 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
537 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
538
539 ** Replace command changes:
540
541 ---
542 *** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
543 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
544 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
545
546 +++
547 *** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
548 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
549 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
550 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
551 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
552 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
553 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
554 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
555 can be edited for each replacement.
556
557 +++
558 *** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
559 `query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
560
561 ---
562 *** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
563 `query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
564
565 ** File operation changes:
566
567 +++
568 *** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
569 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
570 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
571 is only rarely needed.
572
573 +++
574 *** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
575 suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
576
577 +++
578 *** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
579 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
580
581 +++
582 *** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
583 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
584
585 +++
586 *** Auto Compression mode is now enabled by default.
587
588 ---
589 *** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
590
591 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
592 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
593 directory with Dired.
594
595 +++
596 *** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
597 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
598 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
599 file.)
600
601 +++
602 *** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
603 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
604
605 +++
606 *** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
607 add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
608 convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
609 the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
610 commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
611 /tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
612
613 ---
614 *** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
615 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
616 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
617
618 ---
619 *** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
620 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
621 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
622
623 +++
624 *** The new option `write-region-inhibit-fsync' disables calls to fsync
625 in `write-region'. This can be useful on laptops to avoid spinning up
626 the hard drive upon each file save. Enabling this variable may result
627 in data loss, use with care.
628
629 +++
630 *** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
631 Emacs asks for confirmation.
632
633 +++
634 *** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
635
636 `visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
637 when visiting the file.
638
639 `visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
640 needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
641 when saving the file.
642
643 +++
644 *** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
645 major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
646 designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
647 sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
648 So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
649 modes do.
650
651 ** Minibuffer changes:
652
653 +++
654 *** The new file-name-shadow-mode is turned ON by default, so that when
655 entering a file name, any prefix which Emacs will ignore is dimmed.
656
657 +++
658 *** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
659 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
660 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
661 prompt string.
662
663 ---
664 *** Enhanced visual feedback in `*Completions*' buffer.
665
666 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
667 have in common and where they begin to differ.
668
669 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
670 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
671 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
672 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
673 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
674 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
675 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
676 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
677
678 Above fontification is always done when listing completions is
679 triggered at minibuffer. If you want to fontify completions whose
680 listing is triggered at the other normal buffer, you have to pass
681 the common prefix of completions to `display-completion-list' as
682 its second argument.
683
684 +++
685 *** File-name completion can now ignore specified directories.
686 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
687 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
688 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
689 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
690 candidate is a directory.
691
692 +++
693 *** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
694 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
695 it remains unchanged.
696
697 +++
698 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
699 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
700 elements are deleted.
701
702 ** Redisplay changes:
703
704 +++
705 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
706 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
707 appears between the position information and the major mode.
708
709 +++
710 *** New face `escape-glyph' highlights control characters and escape glyphs.
711
712 +++
713 *** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now displayed with a special
714 face, either nobreak-space or escape-glyph. You can turn this off or
715 specify a different mode by setting the variable `nobreak-char-display'.
716
717 +++
718 *** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
719 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
720 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
721 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
722
723 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
724 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
725 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
726 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
727 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
728 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
729
730 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
731 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
732
733 ---
734 *** Moving or scrolling through images (and other lines) taller that
735 the window now works sensibly, by automatically adjusting the window's
736 vscroll property.
737
738 +++
739 *** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
740 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
741 the mode line of the currently selected window.
742
743 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
744 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
745
746 +++
747 *** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
748 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
749 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
750 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
751 set-fringe-style.
752
753 +++
754 *** Angle icons in the fringes can indicate the buffer boundaries. In
755 addition, up and down arrow bitmaps in the fringe indicate which ways
756 the window can be scrolled.
757
758 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
759 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
760 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
761
762 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
763 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
764
765 The value can also be an alist which specifies the presence and
766 position of each bitmap individually.
767
768 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
769 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
770 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
771 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
772
773 +++
774 *** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
775 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
776 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
777 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
778 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
779
780 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' can be set to nil to
781 revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
782
783 +++
784 *** When a window has display margin areas, the fringes are now
785 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
786 outside those margins.
787
788 +++
789 *** A window can now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
790 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
791
792 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
793 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
794 or when the frame is resized.
795
796 ** Cursor display changes:
797
798 +++
799 *** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
800 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
801
802 +++
803 *** The X resource cursorBlink can be used to turn off cursor blinking.
804
805 +++
806 *** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
807 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
808 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
809 cursor does.
810
811 +++
812 *** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
813 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
814 appears in.
815
816 +++
817 *** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
818 of the recognized cursor types.
819
820 ** New faces:
821
822 +++
823 *** `mode-line-highlight' is the standard face indicating mouse sensitive
824 elements on mode-line (and header-line) like `highlight' face on text
825 areas.
826
827 +++
828 *** `shadow' face defines the appearance of the "shadowed" text, i.e.
829 the text which should be less noticeable than the surrounding text.
830 This can be achieved by using shades of grey in contrast with either
831 black or white default foreground color. This generic shadow face
832 allows customization of the appearance of shadowed text in one place,
833 so package-specific faces can inherit from it.
834
835 +++
836 *** `vertical-border' face is used for the vertical divider between windows.
837
838 ** Font-Lock changes:
839
840 +++
841 *** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
842 M-o M-o requests refontification.
843
844 +++
845 *** All modes now support using M-x font-lock-mode to toggle
846 fontification, even those such as Occur, Info, and comint-derived
847 modes that do their own fontification in a special way.
848
849 The variable `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable
850 fontification in Info, remove `turn-on-font-lock' from
851 `Info-mode-hook'.
852
853 +++
854 *** font-lock-lines-before specifies a number of lines before the
855 current line that should be refontified when you change the buffer.
856 The default value is 1.
857
858 +++
859 *** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
860 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
861 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
862 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
863 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
864
865 +++
866 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
867
868 +++
869 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-comment-delimiter-face'.
870
871 +++
872 *** Easy to overlook single character negation can now be font-locked.
873 You can use the new variable `font-lock-negation-char-face' and the face of
874 the same name to customize this. Currently the cc-modes, sh-script-mode,
875 cperl-mode and make-mode support this.
876
877 ---
878 *** The default settings for JIT stealth lock parameters are changed.
879 The default value for the user option jit-lock-stealth-time is now 16
880 instead of 3, and the default value of jit-lock-stealth-nice is now
881 0.5 instead of 0.125. The new defaults should lower the CPU usage
882 when Emacs is fontifying in the background.
883
884 ---
885 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
886
887 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
888 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
889 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
890 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
891
892 ---
893 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
894
895 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
896 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
897 refontification takes place.
898
899 ** Menu support:
900
901 ---
902 *** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
903 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
904 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
905 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
906 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
907 current date and time, current line and column number in the mode-line.
908
909 ---
910 *** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
911
912 ---
913 *** You can exit dialog windows and menus by typing C-g.
914
915 ---
916 *** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
917 and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
918 to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
919
920 +++
921 *** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
922 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
923
924 ---
925 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
926 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
927
928 +++
929 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
930 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
931 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
932
933 ---
934 *** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
935 ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
936
937 +++
938 *** For Gtk+ version 2.4, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
939 by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
940 the new dialog.
941
942 ** Mouse changes:
943
944 +++
945 *** If you set the new variable `mouse-autoselect-window' to a non-nil
946 value, windows are automatically selected as you move the mouse from
947 one Emacs window to another, even within a frame. A minibuffer window
948 can be selected only when it is active.
949
950 +++
951 *** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
952 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
953 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
954 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
955 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
956 to give it focus.
957
958 +++
959 *** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
960
961 Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
962 click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
963 click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
964 inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
965 to match this context-sentitive dual behavior. (If you prefer the old
966 behavior, set the user option `mouse-1-click-follows-link' to nil.)
967
968 Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs can do much
969 more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
970 activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
971 (see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
972 packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
973 this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
974 is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
975 happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
976 on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
977
978 If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
979 just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
980 click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
981 you release it).
982
983 Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
984 drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
985
986 You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
987 `mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
988
989 +++
990 *** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
991 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
992 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
993 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
994 also disable mouse highlighting.
995
996 +++
997 *** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
998 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
999 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
1000
1001 ---
1002 *** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
1003 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
1004
1005 ---
1006 *** Emacs ignores mouse-2 clicks while the mouse wheel is being moved.
1007
1008 People tend to push the mouse wheel (which counts as a mouse-2 click)
1009 unintentionally while turning the wheel, so these clicks are now
1010 ignored. You can customize this with the mouse-wheel-click-event and
1011 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
1012
1013 +++
1014 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
1015
1016 ** Multilingual Environment (Mule) changes:
1017
1018 ---
1019 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
1020 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
1021 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
1022 This change can result in using the different coding systems as
1023 default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
1024
1025 +++
1026 *** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1027 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1028 can mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1029 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1030 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1031 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1032 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1033 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
1034
1035 +++
1036 *** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
1037 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
1038
1039 +++
1040 *** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
1041 coding system.
1042
1043 +++
1044 *** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
1045 of a file.
1046
1047 ---
1048 *** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
1049 unicode.
1050
1051 +++
1052 *** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
1053 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1054 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1055 command.
1056
1057 +++
1058 *** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
1059 in the current input method to input a character at point.
1060
1061 +++
1062 *** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
1063 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1064 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1065 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1066 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1067 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1068 mule-unicode-... ones.
1069
1070 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
1071 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1072 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1073 possible.
1074
1075 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1076 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1077 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
1078 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1079 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
1080
1081 ---
1082 *** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
1083 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1084 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
1085 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
1086
1087 ---
1088 *** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
1089 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
1090 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1091 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1092 automatically according to the locale.)
1093
1094 ---
1095 *** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
1096 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1097 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1098 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
1099 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1100 tamil-inscript.
1101
1102 ---
1103 *** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
1104 characters.
1105
1106 ---
1107 *** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
1108 automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
1109 environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
1110 versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
1111 M-f (forward-word)
1112 M-b (backward-word)
1113 M-d (kill-word)
1114 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
1115 M-t (transpose-words)
1116 M-q (fill-paragraph)
1117
1118 ---
1119 *** Indian support has been updated.
1120 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1121 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
1122 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1123 supported.
1124
1125 ---
1126 *** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
1127
1128 ---
1129 *** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
1130 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1131 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1132 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1133 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1134 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1135 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
1136 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1137 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1138 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
1139 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
1140 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
1141
1142 ---
1143 *** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
1144 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1145 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
1146
1147 ---
1148 *** Many new coding systems are available in the `code-pages' library.
1149 These include complete versions of most of those in codepage.el, based
1150 on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now obsolete and is used
1151 only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. All coding systems defined in
1152 `code-pages' are auto-loaded.
1153
1154 ---
1155 *** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
1156 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
1157
1158 ---
1159 *** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
1160 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1161 fontset appropriately.
1162
1163 ** Customize changes:
1164
1165 +++
1166 *** Custom themes are collections of customize options. Create a
1167 custom theme with M-x customize-create-theme. Use M-x load-theme to
1168 load and enable a theme, and M-x disable-theme to disable it. Use M-x
1169 enable-theme to renable a disabled theme.
1170
1171 +++
1172 *** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
1173 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1174 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1175 faces.
1176
1177 ---
1178 *** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1179 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1180 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1181 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1182 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1183 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1184 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1185
1186 +++
1187 *** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1188 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1189 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1190 under the "[State]" button.
1191
1192 ** Buffer Menu changes:
1193
1194 +++
1195 *** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
1196 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
1197 mode.
1198
1199 +++
1200 *** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1201 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1202 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1203
1204 ---
1205 *** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1206 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1207 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1208
1209 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1210 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
1211 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
1212 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1213 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1214
1215 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1216 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1217 t, and the status is shown.
1218
1219 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1220 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1221
1222 ** Dired mode:
1223
1224 ---
1225 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
1226 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
1227 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
1228
1229 +++
1230 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
1231 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
1232
1233 +++
1234 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
1235 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
1236
1237 +++
1238 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
1239 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
1240 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
1241 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
1242 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
1243 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
1244
1245 +++
1246 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
1247 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
1248
1249 +++
1250 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode.
1251
1252 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command
1253 dired-mark-omitted, bound to * O, marks omitted files. The variable
1254 dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the mode toggling function
1255 instead.
1256
1257 +++
1258 *** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1259 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1260 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1261 directory listing into a buffer.
1262
1263 ** Comint changes:
1264
1265 ---
1266 *** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
1267 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
1268 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
1269 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
1270 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
1271
1272 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
1273 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
1274
1275 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
1276 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
1277 lines, including any prompts.
1278
1279 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
1280 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
1281 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
1282 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
1283 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
1284 `kill-region' if read-only properties are involved: it copies the text
1285 to the kill-ring, but does not delete it.
1286
1287 +++
1288 *** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1289 modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1290 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1291 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1292
1293 +++
1294 *** `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields' has been renamed
1295 `comint-use-prompt-regexp'. The old name has been kept as an alias,
1296 but declared obsolete.
1297
1298 ** M-x Compile changes:
1299
1300 ---
1301 *** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
1302
1303 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
1304 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
1305 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
1306 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
1307
1308 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
1309 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
1310 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
1311
1312 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
1313 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
1314 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
1315 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
1316 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
1317
1318 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
1319
1320 +++
1321 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1322 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1323 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1324 subprocesses inherit.
1325
1326 +++
1327 *** New user option `compilation-disable-input'.
1328 If this is non-nil, send end-of-file as compilation process input.
1329
1330 +++
1331 *** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
1332 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
1333 in new face `next-error'.
1334
1335 +++
1336 *** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
1337 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
1338 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
1339 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
1340 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
1341 C-c C-f.
1342
1343 +++
1344 *** When the left fringe is displayed, an arrow points to current message in
1345 the compilation buffer.
1346
1347 +++
1348 *** The new variable `compilation-context-lines' controls lines of leading
1349 context before the current message. If nil and the left fringe is displayed,
1350 it doesn't scroll the compilation output window. If there is no left fringe,
1351 no arrow is displayed and a value of nil means display the message at the top
1352 of the window.
1353
1354 ** Occur mode changes:
1355
1356 +++
1357 *** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1358 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1359 switching to it.
1360
1361 +++
1362 *** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
1363 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
1364
1365 +++
1366 *** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1367 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1368 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1369 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1370 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1371
1372 ** Grep changes:
1373
1374 +++
1375 *** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
1376
1377 There's a new separate package grep.el, with its own submenu and
1378 customization group.
1379
1380 ---
1381 *** M-x grep provides highlighting support.
1382
1383 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
1384 can be saved and automatically revisited.
1385
1386 +++
1387 *** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
1388 people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
1389
1390 ---
1391 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
1392 `grep-scroll-output' override the corresponding compilation mode
1393 settings, for grep commands only.
1394
1395 +++
1396 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
1397 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
1398 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
1399 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
1400 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
1401 source line is highlighted.
1402
1403 +++
1404 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
1405 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1406 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1407 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1408 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1409 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1410 file.
1411
1412 +++
1413 *** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1414 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1415 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1416 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1417 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1418 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1419
1420 ** X Windows Support:
1421
1422 +++
1423 *** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
1424 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
1425 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
1426
1427 +++
1428 *** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
1429 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
1430 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
1431 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
1432 Meta and Alt:
1433 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
1434 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
1435
1436 +++
1437 *** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which can
1438 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
1439
1440 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
1441 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
1442
1443 ---
1444 *** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1445 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1446 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1447 and use the more appropriately result.
1448
1449 ---
1450 *** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
1451 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1452 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
1453
1454 ** Xterm support:
1455
1456 ---
1457 *** Emacs now responds to mouse-clicks on the mode-line, header-line and
1458 display margin, when run in an xterm.
1459
1460 ---
1461 *** Improved key bindings support when running in an xterm.
1462 When emacs is running in an xterm more key bindings are available. The
1463 following should work:
1464 {C,S,C-S,A}-{right,left,up,down,prior,next,delete,insert,F1-12}.
1465 These key bindings work on xterm from X.org 6.8, they might not work on
1466 some older versions of xterm, or on some proprietary versions.
1467
1468 ** Character terminal color support changes:
1469
1470 +++
1471 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1472 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1473 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1474 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1475 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1476 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1477 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1478 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1479 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1480
1481 ---
1482 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1483 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1484 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1485 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1486 all of these colors.
1487
1488 +++
1489 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1490 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1491 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1492 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1493 colors as on X.
1494
1495 ---
1496 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1497 \f
1498 * New Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1
1499
1500 ** Rcirc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1501
1502 Rcirc is an Internet relay chat (IRC) client. It supports
1503 simultaneous connections to multiple IRC servers. Each discussion
1504 takes place in its own buffer. For each connection you can join
1505 several channels (many-to-many) and participate in private
1506 (one-to-one) chats. Both channel and private chats are contained in
1507 separate buffers.
1508
1509 To start an IRC session, type M-x irc, and follow the prompts for
1510 server, port, nick and initial channels.
1511
1512 ---
1513 ** Newsticker is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1514
1515 Newsticker asynchronously retrieves headlines (RSS) from a list of news
1516 sites, prepares these headlines for reading, and allows for loading the
1517 corresponding articles in a web browser. Its documentation is in a
1518 separate manual.
1519
1520 +++
1521 ** savehist saves minibuffer histories between sessions.
1522 To use this feature, turn on savehist-mode in your `.emacs' file.
1523
1524 +++
1525 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1526 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1527 program files that include other program files.
1528
1529 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1530 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1531 in them.
1532
1533 +++
1534 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1535
1536 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
1537 Emacs Lisp. The prefix for Calc has been changed to `C-x *' and Calc
1538 can be started with `C-x * *'. The Calc manual is separate from the
1539 Emacs manual; within Emacs, type "C-h i m calc RET" to read the
1540 manual. A reference card is available in `etc/calccard.tex' and
1541 `etc/calccard.ps'.
1542
1543 ---
1544 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
1545 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
1546
1547 ---
1548 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1549
1550 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
1551 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
1552 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
1553 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
1554
1555 +++
1556 ** Image files are normally visited in Image mode, which lets you toggle
1557 between viewing the image and viewing the text using C-c C-c.
1558
1559 ---
1560 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1561
1562 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
1563 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
1564 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
1565 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
1566 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
1567 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
1568
1569 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
1570 rectangle highlighting: Use C-return to start a rectangle, extend it
1571 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
1572 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
1573
1574 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
1575 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
1576 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
1577 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
1578 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
1579 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
1580 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
1581
1582 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
1583 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
1584 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
1585
1586 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
1587 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
1588
1589 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
1590 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
1591 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
1592 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
1593
1594 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
1595 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
1596 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you can customize the
1597 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
1598
1599 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
1600 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
1601 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
1602 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
1603
1604 +++
1605 ** Org mode is now part of the Emacs distribution
1606
1607 Org mode is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining ToDo lists, and
1608 doing project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
1609 It also contains a plain-text table editor with spreadsheet-like
1610 capabilities.
1611
1612 The Org mode table editor can be integrated into any major mode by
1613 activating the minor Orgtbl-mode.
1614
1615 The documentation for org-mode is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1616 type "C-h i m org RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1617 available in `etc/orgcard.tex' and `etc/orgcard.ps'.
1618
1619 +++
1620 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
1621 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
1622 to increment the SOA serial.
1623
1624 ---
1625 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
1626 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
1627 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
1628 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
1629 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method can
1630 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
1631
1632 +++
1633 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
1634 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
1635
1636 +++
1637 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
1638 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
1639 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
1640 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
1641 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
1642
1643 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
1644 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
1645 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
1646 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
1647 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
1648 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
1649
1650 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
1651 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
1652 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
1653 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
1654 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
1655 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
1656 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
1657 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
1658 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
1659 or local keymaps.
1660
1661 +++
1662 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
1663 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
1664
1665 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
1666 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
1667 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
1668 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
1669
1670 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
1671 defined macros.
1672
1673 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
1674 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
1675 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
1676 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
1677 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
1678 for more commands.
1679
1680 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
1681 the keyboard macro ring.
1682
1683 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
1684 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
1685
1686 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
1687 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
1688 this behavior via the variables kmacro-call-repeat-key and
1689 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
1690
1691 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
1692 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
1693 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
1694
1695 ---
1696 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
1697 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
1698 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
1699
1700 +++
1701 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
1702 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
1703
1704 +++
1705 ** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
1706 files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
1707 mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
1708 which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
1709 copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
1710 mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
1711 referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
1712 similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
1713 feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
1714
1715 +++
1716 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1717
1718 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
1719 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
1720 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
1721 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
1722 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
1723 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
1724
1725 ---
1726 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
1727 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
1728 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
1729 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
1730
1731 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
1732
1733 ---
1734 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
1735 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
1736 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
1737 settings.
1738
1739 +++
1740 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
1741 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
1742 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
1743 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
1744
1745 +++
1746 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
1747 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
1748
1749 +++
1750 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
1751 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
1752 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
1753 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
1754 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
1755 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
1756
1757 ** The tumme.el package allows you to easily view, tag and in other ways
1758 manipulate image files and their thumbnails, using dired as the main interface.
1759 Tumme provides functionality to generate simple image galleries.
1760
1761 +++
1762 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
1763
1764 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
1765 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
1766 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
1767 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
1768 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
1769 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
1770 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
1771 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
1772 `rsync' to do the copying).
1773
1774 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
1775 `su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
1776
1777 If you want to disable Tramp you should set
1778
1779 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
1780
1781 ---
1782 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
1783
1784 ---
1785 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
1786 configuration files.
1787
1788 +++
1789 ** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
1790 varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
1791 var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
1792 section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
1793 .config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
1794 recognized.
1795
1796 ---
1797 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
1798
1799 +++
1800 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
1801
1802 ---
1803 ** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
1804 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
1805
1806 ** The new package scroll-lock.el provides the Scroll Lock minor mode
1807 for pager-like scrolling. Keys which normally move point by line or
1808 paragraph will scroll the buffer by the respective amount of lines
1809 instead and point will be kept vertically fixed relative to window
1810 boundaries during scrolling.
1811 \f
1812 * Changes in Specialized Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1:
1813
1814 ** Changes in Hi Lock:
1815
1816 +++
1817 *** hi-lock-mode now only affects a single buffer, and a new function
1818 `global-hi-lock-mode' enables Hi Lock in all buffers. By default, if
1819 hi-lock-mode is used in what appears to be the initialization file, a
1820 warning message suggests to use global-hi-lock-mode instead. However,
1821 if the new variable `hi-lock-archaic-interface-deduce' is non-nil,
1822 using hi-lock-mode in an initialization file will turn on Hi Lock in all
1823 buffers and no warning will be issued (for compatibility with the
1824 behavior in older versions of Emacs).
1825
1826 ** Changes in Allout
1827
1828 *** Topic cryptography added, enabling easy gpg topic encryption and
1829 decryption. Per-topic basis enables interspersing encrypted-text and
1830 clear-text within a single file to your hearts content, using symmetric
1831 and/or public key modes. Time-limited key caching, user-provided
1832 symmetric key hinting and consistency verification, auto-encryption of
1833 pending topics on save, and more, make it easy to use encryption in
1834 powerful ways.
1835
1836 *** many substantial fixes and refinements, including:
1837
1838 - repaired inhibition of inadvertent edits to concealed text
1839 - repaired retention of topic body hanging indent upon topic depth shifts
1840 - prevent "containment discontinuities" where a topic is shifted deeper
1841 than the offspring-depth of its container
1842 - easy to adopt the distinctive bullet of a topic in a topic created
1843 relative to it, or select a new one, or use the common topic bullet
1844 - plain bullets, by default, now alternate between only two characters
1845 ('.' and ','), yielding less cluttered outlines
1846 - many internal fixes
1847 - version number incremented to 2.1
1848
1849 ** The variable `woman-topic-at-point' was renamed
1850 to `woman-use-topic-at-point' and behaves differently: if this
1851 variable is non-nil, the `woman' command uses the word at point
1852 automatically, without asking for a confirmation. Otherwise, the word
1853 at point is suggested as default, but not inserted at the prompt.
1854
1855 ---
1856 ** Changes to cmuscheme
1857
1858 *** Emacs now offers to start Scheme if the user tries to
1859 evaluate a Scheme expression but no Scheme subprocess is running.
1860
1861 *** If a file `.emacs_NAME' (where NAME is the name of the Scheme interpreter)
1862 exists in the user's home directory or in ~/.emacs.d, its
1863 contents are sent to the Scheme subprocess upon startup.
1864
1865 *** There are new commands to instruct the Scheme interpreter to trace
1866 procedure calls (`scheme-trace-procedure') and to expand syntactic forms
1867 (`scheme-expand-current-form'). The commands actually sent to the Scheme
1868 subprocess are controlled by the user options `scheme-trace-command',
1869 `scheme-untrace-command' and `scheme-expand-current-form'.
1870
1871 ---
1872 ** Makefile mode has submodes for automake, gmake, makepp and BSD make.
1873
1874 The former two couldn't be differentiated before, and the latter two
1875 are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new customizable
1876 faces.
1877
1878 +++
1879 ** In Outline mode, `hide-body' no longer hides lines at the top
1880 of the file that precede the first header line.
1881
1882 +++
1883 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
1884
1885 ---
1886 ** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved; it can
1887 run most curses applications now.
1888
1889 +++
1890 ** M-x diff uses Diff mode instead of Compilation mode.
1891
1892 +++
1893 ** You can now customize `fill-nobreak-predicate' to control where
1894 filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
1895 functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
1896
1897 Emacs provide two predicates, `fill-single-word-nobreak-p' and
1898 `fill-french-nobreak-p', for use as the value of
1899 `fill-nobreak-predicate'.
1900
1901 ---
1902 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
1903 with special modes such as Tar mode.
1904
1905 ---
1906 ** Commands `winner-redo' and `winner-undo', from winner.el, are now
1907 bound to C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an
1908 incompatible change.
1909
1910 ---
1911 ** `global-whitespace-mode' is a new alias for `whitespace-global-mode'.
1912
1913 +++
1914 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
1915 resync points in both windows.
1916
1917 +++
1918 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1919
1920 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1921 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1922
1923 ---
1924 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
1925 when Emacs visits them.
1926
1927 ** Info mode changes:
1928
1929 +++
1930 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
1931 with the number appended to the `*info*' buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
1932
1933 +++
1934 *** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
1935
1936 Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
1937 message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
1938 other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
1939 aroung the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
1940 `Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
1941 or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
1942 Info node.
1943
1944 ---
1945 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
1946 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
1947 search without prompting for a new search string.
1948
1949 +++
1950 *** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
1951 moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
1952 `Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
1953
1954 ---
1955 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
1956
1957 ---
1958 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
1959 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
1960
1961 +++
1962 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
1963 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
1964 possible matches.
1965
1966 ---
1967 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
1968 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
1969 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
1970
1971 +++
1972 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
1973 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
1974
1975 ---
1976 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
1977 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
1978
1979 +++
1980 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
1981
1982 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
1983 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
1984
1985 ---
1986 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
1987
1988 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
1989 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
1990 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
1991
1992 +++
1993 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
1994
1995 ---
1996 *** `Info-index' offers completion.
1997
1998 ** Lisp mode changes:
1999
2000 ---
2001 *** Lisp mode now uses `font-lock-doc-face' for doc strings.
2002
2003 +++
2004 *** C-u C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-prints the list after point.
2005
2006 *** New features in evaluation commands
2007
2008 +++
2009 **** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
2010 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
2011
2012 +++
2013 **** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
2014 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
2015 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
2016 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
2017 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
2018
2019 +++
2020 ** CC mode changes.
2021
2022 *** The CC Mode manual has been extensively revised.
2023 The information about using CC Mode has been separated from the larger
2024 and more difficult chapters about configuration.
2025
2026 *** Changes in Key Sequences
2027 **** c-toggle-auto-hungry-state is no longer bound to C-c C-t.
2028
2029 **** c-toggle-hungry-state is no longer bound to C-c C-d.
2030 This binding has been taken over by c-hungry-delete-forwards.
2031
2032 **** c-toggle-auto-state (C-c C-t) has been renamed to c-toggle-auto-newline.
2033 c-toggle-auto-state remains as an alias.
2034
2035 **** The new commands c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forwards
2036 have key bindings C-c C-DEL (or C-c DEL, for the benefit of TTYs) and
2037 C-c C-d (or C-c C-<delete> or C-c <delete>) respectively. These
2038 commands delete entire blocks of whitespace with a single
2039 key-sequence. [N.B. "DEL" is the <backspace> key.]
2040
2041 **** The new command c-toggle-electric-mode is bound to C-c C-l.
2042
2043 **** The new command c-subword-mode is bound to C-c C-w.
2044
2045 *** C-c C-s (`c-show-syntactic-information') now highlights the anchor
2046 position(s).
2047
2048 *** New Minor Modes
2049 **** Electric Minor Mode toggles the electric action of non-alphabetic keys.
2050 The new command c-toggle-electric-mode is bound to C-c C-l. Turning the
2051 mode off can be helpful for editing chaotically indented code and for
2052 users new to CC Mode, who sometimes find electric indentation
2053 disconcerting. Its current state is displayed in the mode line with an
2054 'l', e.g. "C/al".
2055
2056 **** Subword Minor Mode makes Emacs recognize word boundaries at upper case
2057 letters in StudlyCapsIdentifiers. You enable this feature by C-c C-w. It can
2058 also be used in non-CC Mode buffers. :-) Contributed by Masatake YAMATO.
2059
2060 *** New clean-ups
2061
2062 **** `comment-close-slash'.
2063 With this clean-up, a block (i.e. c-style) comment can be terminated by
2064 typing a slash at the start of a line.
2065
2066 **** `c-one-liner-defun'
2067 This clean-up compresses a short enough defun (for example, an AWK
2068 pattern/action pair) onto a single line. "Short enough" is configurable.
2069
2070 *** Font lock support.
2071 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
2072 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
2073 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
2074 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
2075 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
2076 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
2077
2078 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
2079 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
2080 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
2081 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
2082 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
2083 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
2084 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
2085 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
2086 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
2087
2088 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
2089 fontification in mind; Just-In-Time-Lock mode should be enabled for
2090 the highest font lock level (by default, it is). Fontifying a file
2091 with several thousand lines in one go can take the better part of a
2092 minute.
2093
2094 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
2095 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
2096 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
2097 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
2098 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
2099 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
2100
2101 **** Support for documentation comments.
2102 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
2103 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
2104 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
2105 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
2106
2107 Currently three kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Sun's
2108 Javadoc, Autodoc (which is used in Pike) and GtkDoc (used in C). (The
2109 last was contributed by Masatake YAMATO). This is by no means a
2110 complete list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor
2111 of choice is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2112
2113 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
2114 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
2115 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
2116 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
2117 parens.
2118
2119 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
2120 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
2121 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
2122 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
2123 not as configurable as it ought to be.
2124
2125 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
2126 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
2127 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
2128 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
2129 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
2130
2131 *** Support for the AWK language.
2132 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
2133 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
2134 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
2135 Here is a summary:
2136
2137 **** Indentation Engine
2138 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
2139
2140 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
2141 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
2142 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
2143 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
2144 definition, or structured statement.
2145
2146 The predefined line-up functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
2147 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't
2148 be any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
2149
2150 **** Font Locking
2151 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
2152 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
2153 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
2154 the AWK language itself.
2155
2156 **** Comment and Movement Commands
2157 These commands all work for AWK buffers. The notion of "defun" has
2158 been augmented to include AWK pattern-action pairs - the standard
2159 "defun" commands on key sequences C-M-a, C-M-e, and C-M-h use this
2160 extended definition.
2161
2162 **** "awk" style, Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
2163 A new style, "awk" has been introduced, and this is now the default
2164 style for AWK code. With auto-newline enabled, the clean-up
2165 c-one-liner-defun (see above) is useful.
2166
2167 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
2168 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
2169 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
2170 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
2171 composition-close, and incomposition.
2172
2173 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
2174 The new functions `c-hungry-backspace' and `c-hungry-delete-forward'
2175 provide hungry deletion without having to toggle a mode. They are
2176 bound to C-c C-DEL and C-c C-d (and several variants, for the benefit
2177 of different keyboard setups. See "Changes in key sequences" above).
2178
2179 *** Better control over `require-final-newline'.
2180
2181 The variable `c-require-final-newline' specifies which of the modes
2182 implemented by CC mode should insert final newlines. Its value is a
2183 list of modes, and only those modes should do it. By default the list
2184 includes C, C++ and Objective-C modes.
2185
2186 Whichever modes are in this list will set `require-final-newline'
2187 based on `mode-require-final-newline'.
2188
2189 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
2190
2191 The elements in the syntactic context returned by `c-guess-basic-syntax'
2192 and stored in `c-syntactic-context' has been changed somewhat to allow
2193 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
2194 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
2195
2196 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
2197
2198 is now analyzed as
2199
2200 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
2201
2202 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
2203 symbol.
2204
2205 This change might affect code that calls `c-guess-basic-syntax'
2206 directly, and custom lineup functions if they use
2207 `c-syntactic-context'. However, the argument given to lineup
2208 functions is still a single cons cell with nil or an integer in the
2209 cdr.
2210
2211 *** API changes for derived modes.
2212
2213 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2214 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2215 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2216 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2217 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
2218
2219 **** New language variable system.
2220 These are variables whose values vary between CC Mode's different
2221 languages. See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
2222
2223 **** New initialization functions.
2224 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2225 give better control: `c-basic-common-init', `c-font-lock-init', and
2226 `c-init-language-vars'.
2227
2228 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2229 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2230 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2231 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
2232
2233 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2234 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2235 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2236 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2237 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2238
2239 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2240 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2241 its substatement. E.g:
2242
2243 if (x)
2244 x_is_true:
2245 do_stuff();
2246
2247 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
2248
2249 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2250 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2251 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2252 variable `c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros'. A new syntactic symbol
2253 `cpp-define-intro' has been added to control the initial indentation
2254 inside `#define's.
2255
2256 **** New lineup function `c-lineup-cpp-define'.
2257
2258 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2259 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2260 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2261 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2262 much line `c-lineup-dont-change', which was used earlier, but handles
2263 empty lines within the macro better.
2264
2265 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2266 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2267 `c-context-line-break' and `c-context-open-line'.
2268
2269 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2270 `c-backslash-region' tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2271 variable `c-backslash-max-column' puts a limit on how far out
2272 backslashes can be moved.
2273
2274 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2275 This is controlled by the new variable `c-auto-align-backslashes'. It
2276 affects `c-context-line-break', `c-context-open-line' and newlines
2277 inserted in Auto-Newline mode.
2278
2279 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2280 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2281 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2282 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2283 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2284 backslash) in the macro.
2285
2286 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2287 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2288 the variable `c-indent-comment-alist'. The indentation behavior is
2289 based on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after
2290 #else and #endif but indentation to `comment-column' in most other
2291 cases (something which was hardcoded earlier).
2292
2293 *** New function `c-context-open-line'.
2294 It's the open-line equivalent of `c-context-line-break'.
2295
2296 *** New lineup functions
2297
2298 **** `c-lineup-string-cont'
2299 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2300 continues. E.g:
2301
2302 result = prefix + "A message "
2303 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2304
2305 **** `c-lineup-cascaded-calls'
2306 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2307
2308 **** `c-lineup-knr-region-comment'
2309 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2310 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2311
2312 **** `c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg'
2313 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks.
2314
2315 **** `c-lineup-argcont'
2316 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2317
2318 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2319 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2320 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2321 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2322 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2323 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2324
2325 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2326 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2327 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2328 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2329 context.
2330
2331 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2332 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2333 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2334 happen when macros are involved.
2335
2336 *** Improved the way `c-indent-exp' chooses the block to indent.
2337 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2338 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2339 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2340 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2341 line is left untouched.
2342
2343 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2344 The function `c-toggle-syntactic-indentation' can be used to toggle
2345 syntactic indentation.
2346
2347 ** In sh-script, a continuation line is only indented if the backslash was
2348 preceded by a SPC or a TAB.
2349
2350 ---
2351 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
2352
2353 ---
2354 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2355 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2356 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2357 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2358
2359 ** Fortran mode changes:
2360
2361 ---
2362 *** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
2363 highlighting for the old default.
2364
2365 +++
2366 *** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2367 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2368 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
2369
2370 +++
2371 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
2372 `f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
2373 `f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
2374 `fortran-beginning-of-block'.
2375
2376 ---
2377 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for `hs-minor-mode' (hideshow).
2378 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2379 majority.
2380
2381 ---
2382 *** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2383 the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2384
2385 ---
2386 ** Reftex mode changes
2387 +++
2388 *** Changes to RefTeX's table of contents
2389
2390 The new command keys "<" and ">" in the TOC buffer promote/demote the
2391 section at point or all sections in the current region, with full
2392 support for multifile documents.
2393
2394 The new command `reftex-toc-recenter' (`C-c -') shows the current
2395 section in the TOC buffer without selecting the TOC window.
2396 Recentering can happen automatically in idle time when the option
2397 `reftex-auto-recenter-toc' is turned on. The highlight in the TOC
2398 buffer stays when the focus moves to a different window. A dedicated
2399 frame can show the TOC with the current section always automatically
2400 highlighted. The frame is created and deleted from the toc buffer
2401 with the `d' key.
2402
2403 The toc window can be split off horizontally instead of vertically.
2404 See new option `reftex-toc-split-windows-horizontally'.
2405
2406 Labels can be renamed globally from the table of contents using the
2407 key `M-%'.
2408
2409 The new command `reftex-goto-label' jumps directly to a label
2410 location.
2411
2412 +++
2413 *** Changes related to citations and BibTeX database files
2414
2415 Commands that insert a citation now prompt for optional arguments when
2416 called with a prefix argument. Related new options are
2417 `reftex-cite-prompt-optional-args' and `reftex-cite-cleanup-optional-args'.
2418
2419 The new command `reftex-create-bibtex-file' creates a BibTeX database
2420 with all entries referenced in the current document. The keys "e" and
2421 "E" allow to produce a BibTeX database file from entries marked in a
2422 citation selection buffer.
2423
2424 The command `reftex-citation' uses the word in the buffer before the
2425 cursor as a default search string.
2426
2427 The support for chapterbib has been improved. Different chapters can
2428 now use BibTeX or an explicit `thebibliography' environment.
2429
2430 The macros which specify the bibliography file (like \bibliography)
2431 can be configured with the new option `reftex-bibliography-commands'.
2432
2433 Support for jurabib has been added.
2434
2435 +++
2436 *** Global index matched may be verified with a user function
2437
2438 During global indexing, a user function can verify an index match.
2439 See new option `reftex-index-verify-function'.
2440
2441 +++
2442 *** Parsing documents with many labels can be sped up.
2443
2444 Operating in a document with thousands of labels can be sped up
2445 considerably by allowing RefTeX to derive the type of a label directly
2446 from the label prefix like `eq:' or `fig:'. The option
2447 `reftex-trust-label-prefix' needs to be configured in order to enable
2448 this feature. While the speed-up is significant, this may reduce the
2449 quality of the context offered by RefTeX to describe a label.
2450
2451 +++
2452 *** Miscellaneous changes
2453
2454 The macros which input a file in LaTeX (like \input, \include) can be
2455 configured in the new option `reftex-include-file-commands'.
2456
2457 RefTeX supports global incremental search.
2458
2459 +++
2460 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2461 to support use of font-lock.
2462
2463 ** HTML/SGML changes:
2464
2465 ---
2466 *** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
2467 automatically.
2468
2469 +++
2470 *** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2471 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
2472 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2473 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2474 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2475 from the file name or buffer contents.
2476
2477 +++
2478 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
2479
2480 ** TeX modes:
2481
2482 +++
2483 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
2484
2485 +++
2486 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
2487 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
2488 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
2489 TeX commands to use at startup.
2490
2491 ---
2492 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
2493 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
2494
2495 +++
2496 *** New major mode Doctex mode, for *.dtx files.
2497
2498 ** BibTeX mode:
2499
2500 *** The new command `bibtex-url' browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
2501 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
2502
2503 *** The new command `bibtex-entry-update' (bound to C-c C-u) updates
2504 an existing BibTeX entry.
2505
2506 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
2507
2508 *** `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' can take values `plain',
2509 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
2510 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
2511 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
2512 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
2513 `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' is non-nil.
2514
2515 *** If the new variable `bibtex-parse-keys-fast' is non-nil,
2516 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
2517
2518 *** If the new variable `bibtex-autoadd-commas' is non-nil,
2519 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
2520
2521 *** The new variable `bibtex-autofill-types' contains a list of entry
2522 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
2523
2524 *** The new command `bibtex-complete' completes word fragment before
2525 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
2526
2527 *** The new commands `bibtex-find-entry' and `bibtex-find-crossref'
2528 locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
2529 Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
2530
2531 *** In BibTeX mode the command `fill-paragraph' (M-q) fills
2532 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
2533
2534 *** The new variables `bibtex-files' and `bibtex-file-path' define a set
2535 of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
2536
2537 *** The new command `bibtex-validate-globally' checks for duplicate keys
2538 in multiple BibTeX files.
2539
2540 *** The new command `bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill' pushes summary
2541 of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
2542
2543 *** The new variables bibtex-expand-strings and
2544 bibtex-autokey-expand-strings control the expansion of strings when
2545 extracting the content of a BibTeX field.
2546
2547 +++
2548 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
2549 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
2550 and `C-c C-r'.
2551
2552 ** GUD changes:
2553
2554 +++
2555 *** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
2556 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
2557
2558 ---
2559 *** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
2560 and other common debugger commands.
2561
2562 +++
2563 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
2564 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
2565 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
2566 state of your program. It can separate the input/output of your program from
2567 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
2568 Emacs 21/22 such as the toolbar, and bitmaps in the fringe to indicate
2569 breakpoints.
2570
2571 Use M-x gdb to start GDB-UI.
2572
2573 *** The variable tooltip-gud-tips-p has been removed. GUD tooltips can now be
2574 toggled independently of normal tooltips with the minor mode
2575 `gud-tooltip-mode'.
2576
2577 +++
2578 *** In graphical mode, with a C program, GUD Tooltips have been extended to
2579 display the #define directive associated with an identifier when program is
2580 not executing.
2581
2582 ---
2583 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
2584
2585 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
2586 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
2587 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
2588 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2589 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
2590
2591 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
2592 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
2593 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
2594 (gud-finish).
2595
2596 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
2597 (Java 1.1 jdb).
2598
2599 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
2600 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
2601 Set `gud-jdb-use-classpath' to nil.
2602
2603 Added Customization Variables
2604
2605 *** `gud-jdb-command-name'. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
2606
2607 *** `gud-jdb-use-classpath'. Allows selection of java source file searching
2608 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan `gud-jdb-directories' for
2609 java sources (previous method).
2610
2611 *** `gud-jdb-directories'. List of directories to scan and search for java
2612 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2613 is nil).
2614
2615 Minor Improvements
2616
2617 *** The STARTTLS wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
2618 instead of the OpenSSL based `starttls' tool. For backwards
2619 compatibility, it prefers `starttls', but you can toggle
2620 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
2621 `starttls' tool).
2622
2623 *** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
2624
2625 ** Auto-Revert changes:
2626
2627 +++
2628 *** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
2629
2630 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
2631 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
2632 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
2633 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
2634 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
2635 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior can
2636 be mode dependent.
2637
2638 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
2639 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
2640 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
2641 toggles this mode.
2642
2643 +++
2644 *** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
2645 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
2646 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
2647 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
2648 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
2649 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
2650 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
2651 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
2652 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
2653
2654 +++
2655 *** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
2656 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
2657 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
2658 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
2659 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
2660
2661 ---
2662 ** recentf changes.
2663
2664 The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
2665 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
2666 automatic cleanup.
2667
2668 The ten most recent files can be quickly opened by using the shortcut
2669 keys 1 to 9, and 0, when the recent list is displayed in a buffer via
2670 the `recentf-open-files', or `recentf-open-more-files' commands.
2671
2672 The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
2673 and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
2674 keep in the recent list.
2675
2676 With the more advanced option `recentf-filename-handlers', you can
2677 specify functions that successively transform recent file names. For
2678 example, if set to `file-truename' plus `abbreviate-file-name', the
2679 same file will not be in the recent list with different symbolic
2680 links, and the file name will be abbreviated.
2681
2682 To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
2683 replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
2684 old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
2685
2686 +++
2687 ** Desktop package
2688
2689 +++
2690 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, `desktop-save-mode'.
2691
2692 +++
2693 *** The variable `desktop-enable' is obsolete.
2694
2695 Customize `desktop-save-mode' to enable desktop saving.
2696
2697 ---
2698 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
2699 buffer list.
2700
2701 +++
2702 *** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers
2703 immediately, remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is
2704 idle).
2705
2706 +++
2707 *** New commands:
2708 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
2709 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
2710 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
2711 it was loaded.
2712 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
2713 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
2714
2715 ---
2716 *** New customizable variables:
2717 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
2718 killed.
2719 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
2720 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
2721 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
2722 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
2723 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
2724 should not delete.
2725 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
2726 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
2727 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
2728 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
2729
2730 +++
2731 *** New command line option --no-desktop
2732
2733 ---
2734 *** New hooks:
2735 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
2736 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
2737
2738 ---
2739 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
2740
2741 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
2742 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
2743 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
2744 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
2745 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
2746 feature.
2747
2748 ** EDiff changes.
2749
2750 +++
2751 *** When comparing directories.
2752 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
2753 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
2754 from one directory to another.
2755
2756 +++
2757 *** When comparing files or buffers.
2758 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
2759 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
2760 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
2761 comparison.
2762
2763 +++
2764 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
2765 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
2766 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
2767
2768 +++
2769 ** Etags changes.
2770
2771 *** New regular expressions features
2772
2773 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
2774
2775 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
2776 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
2777 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
2778 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
2779 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
2780 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
2781 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
2782 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
2783 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
2784 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
2785
2786 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in GCC.
2787
2788 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
2789 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
2790 CR, TAB, VT,
2791
2792 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
2793
2794 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
2795 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
2796 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
2797
2798 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
2799
2800 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
2801 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
2802
2803 *** New language parsing features
2804
2805 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
2806
2807 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
2808
2809 **** The GCC __attribute__ keyword is now recognized and ignored.
2810
2811 **** New language HTML.
2812
2813 Tags are generated for `title' as well as `h1', `h2', and `h3'. Also,
2814 when `name=' is used inside an anchor and whenever `id=' is used.
2815
2816 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
2817
2818 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
2819 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
2820
2821 **** New language Lua.
2822
2823 All functions are tagged.
2824
2825 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
2826
2827 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
2828 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
2829 package::sub.
2830
2831 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
2832
2833 **** New language PHP.
2834
2835 Functions, classes and defines are tags. If the --members option is
2836 specified to etags, variables are tags also.
2837
2838 **** New default keywords for TeX.
2839
2840 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
2841 renewenvironment.
2842
2843 *** Honour #line directives.
2844
2845 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
2846 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
2847 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
2848 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
2849 writes tags pointing to the source file.
2850
2851 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
2852
2853 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
2854 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
2855 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
2856 the file FILE.
2857
2858 ** VC Changes
2859
2860 +++
2861 *** The key C-x C-q only changes the read-only state of the buffer
2862 (toggle-read-only). It no longer checks files in or out.
2863
2864 We made this change because we held a poll and found that many users
2865 were unhappy with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this
2866 behavior, you can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your
2867 `.emacs' file:
2868
2869 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
2870
2871 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
2872
2873 +++
2874 *** The new variable `vc-cvs-global-switches' specifies switches that
2875 are passed to any CVS command invoked by VC.
2876
2877 These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which means they
2878 are inserted before the command name. For example, this allows you to
2879 specify a compression level using the `-z#' option for CVS.
2880
2881 +++
2882 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
2883
2884 +++
2885 *** VC-Annotate mode enhancements
2886
2887 In VC-Annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2888 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2889 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2890
2891 P: annotates the previous revision
2892 N: annotates the next revision
2893 J: annotates the revision at line
2894 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2895 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2896 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2897 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2898
2899 ** pcl-cvs changes:
2900
2901 +++
2902 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2903 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2904 in the repository.
2905
2906 +++
2907 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2908 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2909 `checkout', `update' or `commit'. That means using cvs diff options
2910 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2911
2912 +++
2913 ** The new variable `mail-default-directory' specifies
2914 `default-directory' for mail buffers. This directory is used for
2915 auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to "~/".
2916
2917 +++
2918 ** The mode line can indicate new mail in a directory or file.
2919
2920 See the documentation of the user option
2921 `display-time-mail-directory'.
2922
2923 ** Rmail changes:
2924
2925 ---
2926 *** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2927
2928 *** The new commands rmail-end-of-message and rmail-summary end-of-message,
2929 by default bound to `/', go to the end of the current mail message in
2930 Rmail and Rmail summary buffers.
2931
2932 +++
2933 *** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
2934
2935 This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
2936 mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
2937 without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
2938 and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
2939 used instead of the native one.
2940
2941 ** Gnus package
2942
2943 ---
2944 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
2945
2946 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
2947 PGP/MIME.
2948
2949 ---
2950 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
2951
2952 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
2953
2954 ---
2955 ** MH-E changes.
2956
2957 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.85. There have been major changes since
2958 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
2959
2960 ** Calendar changes:
2961
2962 +++
2963 *** You can now use < and >, instead of C-x < and C-x >, to scroll
2964 the calendar left or right. (The old key bindings still work too.)
2965
2966 +++
2967 *** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
2968 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
2969
2970 +++
2971 *** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
2972 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
2973 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
2974 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
2975 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
2976 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
2977 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
2978 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
2979 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
2980
2981 +++
2982 *** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
2983 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
2984 count backward from the end of the year.
2985
2986 +++
2987 *** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
2988 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
2989 day of that ISO week.
2990
2991 ---
2992 *** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
2993 window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
2994
2995 ---
2996 *** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
2997 optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
2998 rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
2999 `christian-holidays' simpler.
3000
3001 ---
3002 *** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
3003 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
3004 and `diary-header-line-format'.
3005
3006 +++
3007 *** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed:
3008 use the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
3009 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
3010 `appt-issue-message', `appt-visible', and `appt-msg-window'.
3011
3012 +++
3013 *** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
3014 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
3015 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
3016 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
3017 formats.
3018
3019 +++
3020 ** Speedbar changes:
3021
3022 *** Speedbar items can now be selected by clicking mouse-1, based on
3023 the `mouse-1-click-follows-link' mechanism.
3024
3025 *** SPC and DEL are no longer bound to scroll up/down in the speedbar
3026 keymap.
3027
3028 *** The new command `speedbar-toggle-line-expansion', bound to SPC,
3029 contracts or expands the line under the cursor.
3030
3031 *** New command `speedbar-create-directory', bound to `M'.
3032
3033 *** The new commands `speedbar-expand-line-descendants' and
3034 `speedbar-contract-line-descendants', bound to `[' and `]'
3035 respectively, expand and contract the line under cursor with all of
3036 its descendents.
3037
3038 *** The new user option `speedbar-query-confirmation-method' controls
3039 how querying is performed for file operations. A value of 'always
3040 means to always query before file operations; 'none-but-delete means
3041 to not query before any file operations, except before a file
3042 deletion.
3043
3044 *** The new user option `speedbar-select-frame-method' specifies how
3045 to select a frame for displaying a file opened with the speedbar. A
3046 value of 'attached means to use the attached frame (the frame that
3047 speedbar was started from.) A number such as 1 or -1 means to pass
3048 that number to `other-frame'.
3049
3050 *** The new user option `speedbar-use-tool-tips-flag', if non-nil,
3051 means to display tool-tips for speedbar items.
3052
3053 *** The frame management code in speedbar.el has been split into a new
3054 `dframe' library. Emacs Lisp code that makes use of the speedbar
3055 should use `dframe-attached-frame' instead of
3056 `speedbar-attached-frame', `dframe-timer' instead of `speedbar-timer',
3057 `dframe-close-frame' instead of `speedbar-close-frame', and
3058 `dframe-activity-change-focus-flag' instead of
3059 `speedbar-activity-change-focus-flag'. The variables
3060 `speedbar-update-speed' and `speedbar-navigating-speed' are also
3061 obsolete; use `dframe-update-speed' instead.
3062
3063 ---
3064 ** sql changes.
3065
3066 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
3067 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
3068 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
3069 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
3070 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
3071
3072 The following values are supported:
3073
3074 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
3075 db2 DB2
3076 informix Informix
3077 ingres Ingres
3078 interbase Interbase
3079 linter Linter
3080 ms Microsoft
3081 mysql MySQL
3082 oracle Oracle
3083 postgres Postgres
3084 solid Solid
3085 sqlite SQLite
3086 sybase Sybase
3087
3088 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
3089 SQL mode indicator.
3090
3091 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
3092 your `.emacs' will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
3093 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
3094
3095 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
3096
3097 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
3098 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
3099 all identifiers ending in `_t' under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
3100 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
3101
3102 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
3103 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
3104
3105 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i.
3106
3107 Most SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
3108 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
3109
3110 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
3111
3112 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
3113 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
3114 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
3115 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
3116 terminated.
3117
3118 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
3119 called with the `-E' command line argument to use the operating system
3120 credentials to authenticate the user.
3121
3122 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
3123 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
3124 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
3125
3126 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
3127 Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
3128
3129 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
3130 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
3131 defaults.
3132
3133 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
3134 appropriate `sql-interactive-mode' wrapper for the current setting of
3135 `sql-product'.
3136
3137 ---
3138 *** sql.el supports the SQLite interpreter--call 'sql-sqlite'.
3139
3140 ** FFAP changes:
3141
3142 +++
3143 *** New ffap commands and keybindings:
3144
3145 C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
3146 C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
3147 C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
3148 C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
3149
3150 ---
3151 *** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default.
3152
3153 C-x C-f passes the file name to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS
3154 argument, which visits multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
3155
3156 ---
3157 ** In skeleton.el, `-' marks the `skeleton-point' without interregion interaction.
3158
3159 `@' has reverted to only setting `skeleton-positions' and no longer
3160 sets `skeleton-point'. Skeletons which used @ to mark
3161 `skeleton-point' independent of `_' should now use `-' instead. The
3162 updated `skeleton-insert' docstring explains these new features along
3163 with other details of skeleton construction.
3164
3165 ---
3166 ** Hideshow mode changes
3167
3168 *** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
3169 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
3170 handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
3171 temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
3172
3173 *** New variable `hs-allow-nesting' non-nil means that hiding a block does
3174 not discard the hidden state of any "internal" blocks; when the parent
3175 block is later shown, the internal blocks remain hidden. Default is nil.
3176
3177 +++
3178 ** `hide-ifdef-mode' now uses overlays rather than selective-display
3179 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
3180 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
3181
3182 ---
3183 ** `partial-completion-mode' now handles partial completion on directory names.
3184
3185 ---
3186 ** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
3187 and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
3188 you don't want the `.type-break' file in your home directory or are
3189 annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
3190
3191 ---
3192 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
3193
3194 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
3195 `ps-print', provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF
3196 fonts. See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
3197
3198 ---
3199 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
3200 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
3201 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
3202 using strokes as an input method.
3203
3204 ** Emacs server changes:
3205
3206 +++
3207 *** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
3208
3209 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
3210 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
3211 % emacsclient -s foo file1
3212 % emacsclient -s bar file2
3213
3214 +++
3215 *** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
3216 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given Lisp
3217 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
3218
3219 +++
3220 *** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
3221
3222 ---
3223 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
3224
3225 +++
3226 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
3227
3228 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
3229 argument it toggles the mode. Turning off PC-Selection mode restores
3230 the global key bindings that were replaced by turning on the mode.
3231
3232 ---
3233 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
3234 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
3235
3236 ---
3237 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
3238
3239 Emacs still works on terminals that require magic cookies in order to
3240 use standout mode, but they can no longer display mode-lines in
3241 inverse-video.
3242
3243 ---
3244 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
3245
3246 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
3247 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
3248 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
3249
3250 ** battery.el changes:
3251
3252 ---
3253 *** display-battery-mode replaces display-battery.
3254
3255 ---
3256 *** battery.el now works on recent versions of OS X.
3257
3258 ---
3259 ** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode.
3260
3261 To enable this, set `calculator-output-radix' non-nil. In this mode a
3262 separator character is used every few digits, making it easier to see
3263 byte boundries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the
3264 variable `calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
3265
3266 ---
3267 ** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
3268
3269 ---
3270 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
3271
3272 ---
3273 ** cplus-md.el has been deleted.
3274 \f
3275 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems
3276
3277 +++
3278 ** The HOME directory defaults to Application Data under the user profile.
3279
3280 If you used a previous version of Emacs without setting the HOME
3281 environment variable and a `.emacs' was saved, then Emacs will continue
3282 using C:/ as the default HOME. But if you are installing Emacs afresh,
3283 the default location will be the "Application Data" (or similar
3284 localized name) subdirectory of your user profile. A typical location
3285 of this directory is "C:\Documents and Settings\USERNAME\Application Data",
3286 where USERNAME is your user name.
3287
3288 This change means that users can now have their own `.emacs' files on
3289 shared computers, and the default HOME directory is less likely to be
3290 read-only on computers that are administered by someone else.
3291
3292 +++
3293 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
3294
3295 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
3296 existing values. For example:
3297
3298 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
3299
3300 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
3301 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
3302
3303 ---
3304 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
3305
3306 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
3307 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
3308
3309 ---
3310 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
3311
3312 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
3313
3314 ---
3315 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
3316
3317 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
3318 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
3319 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
3320 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
3321 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
3322 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
3323
3324 ---
3325 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
3326
3327 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
3328 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
3329 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
3330 sound support for those formats.
3331
3332 ---
3333 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
3334
3335 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
3336
3337 ---
3338 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
3339
3340 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
3341 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
3342 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
3343
3344 ---
3345 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
3346
3347 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
3348 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
3349 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
3350 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
3351 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
3352 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
3353 you wish to use them in other faces.
3354
3355 ---
3356 ** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
3357
3358 Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
3359 multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
3360 MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
3361 the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
3362 any customizations.
3363
3364 ---
3365 ** Running in a console window in Windows now uses the console size.
3366
3367 Previous versions of Emacs erred on the side of having a usable Emacs
3368 through telnet, even though that was inconvenient if you use Emacs in
3369 a local console window with a scrollback buffer. The default value of
3370 w32-use-full-screen-buffer is now nil, which favours local console
3371 windows. Recent versions of Windows telnet also work well with this
3372 setting. If you are using an older telnet server then Emacs detects
3373 that the console window dimensions that are reported are not sane, and
3374 defaults to 80x25. If you use such a telnet server regularly at a size
3375 other than 80x25, you can still manually set
3376 w32-use-full-screen-buffer to t.
3377
3378 ---
3379 ** On Mac OS, `keyboard-coding-system' changes based on the keyboard script.
3380
3381 ---
3382 ** The variable `mac-keyboard-text-encoding' and the constants
3383 `kTextEncodingMacRoman', `kTextEncodingISOLatin1', and
3384 `kTextEncodingISOLatin2' are obsolete.
3385
3386 ** The variable `mac-command-key-is-meta' is obsolete. Use
3387 `mac-command-modifier' and `mac-option-modifier' instead.
3388 \f
3389 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3390
3391 ---
3392 ** The variables post-command-idle-hook and post-command-idle-delay have
3393 been removed. Use run-with-idle-timer instead.
3394
3395 +++
3396 ** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
3397 the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
3398 `substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
3399 `undefined'.)
3400
3401 +++
3402 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3403 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3404 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
3405
3406 ---
3407 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3408
3409 +++
3410 ** The variable `memory-full' now remains t until
3411 there is no longer a shortage of memory.
3412 \f
3413 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3414
3415 ** General Lisp changes:
3416
3417 *** The function `expt' handles negative exponents differently.
3418 The value for `(expt A B)', if both A and B are integers and B is
3419 negative, is now a float. For example: (expt 2 -2) => 0.25.
3420
3421 +++
3422 *** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
3423
3424 +++
3425 *** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
3426
3427 +++
3428 *** `add-to-list' takes an optional third argument, APPEND.
3429
3430 If APPEND is non-nil, the new element gets added at the end of the
3431 list instead of at the beginning. This change actually occurred in
3432 Emacs 21.1, but was not documented then.
3433
3434 +++
3435 *** New function `add-to-ordered-list' is like `add-to-list' but
3436 associates a numeric ordering of each element added to the list.
3437
3438 +++
3439 *** New function `copy-tree' makes a copy of a tree.
3440
3441 It recursively copyies through both CARs and CDRs.
3442
3443 +++
3444 *** New function `delete-dups' deletes `equal' duplicate elements from a list.
3445
3446 It modifies the list destructively, like `delete'. Of several `equal'
3447 occurrences of an element in the list, the one that's kept is the
3448 first one.
3449
3450 +++
3451 *** New function `rassq-delete-all'.
3452
3453 (rassq-delete-all VALUE ALIST) deletes, from ALIST, each element whose
3454 CDR is `eq' to the specified value.
3455
3456 +++
3457 *** The function `number-sequence' makes a list of equally-separated numbers.
3458
3459 For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9). By
3460 default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different
3461 separation as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns
3462 (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3463
3464 +++
3465 *** New variables `most-positive-fixnum' and `most-negative-fixnum'.
3466
3467 They hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3468
3469 +++
3470 *** Minor change in the function `format'.
3471
3472 Some flags that were accepted but not implemented (such as "*") are no
3473 longer accepted.
3474
3475 +++
3476 *** Functions `get' and `plist-get' no longer give errors for bad plists.
3477
3478 They return nil for a malformed property list or if the list is
3479 cyclic.
3480
3481 +++
3482 *** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3483
3484 They are like `plist-get' and `plist-put', except that they compare
3485 the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3486
3487 +++
3488 *** New variable `print-continuous-numbering'.
3489
3490 When this is non-nil, successive calls to print functions use a single
3491 numbering scheme for circular structure references. This is only
3492 relevant when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3493
3494 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3495 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3496
3497 +++
3498 *** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
3499
3500 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
3501 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
3502 if no expansion is done, which can be tested using `eq'.
3503
3504 +++
3505 *** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3506
3507 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3508 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3509 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3510
3511 +++
3512 *** A function or macro's doc string can now specify the calling pattern.
3513
3514 You put this info in the doc string's last line. It should be
3515 formatted so as to match the regexp "\n\n(fn .*)\\'". If you don't
3516 specify this explicitly, Emacs determines it from the actual argument
3517 names. Usually that default is right, but not always.
3518
3519 +++
3520 *** New macro `with-local-quit' temporarily allows quitting.
3521
3522 A quit inside the body of `with-local-quit' is caught by the
3523 `with-local-quit' form itself, but another quit will happen later once
3524 the code that has inhibitted quitting exits.
3525
3526 This is for use around potentially blocking or long-running code
3527 inside timer functions and `post-command-hook' functions.
3528
3529 +++
3530 *** New macro `define-obsolete-function-alias'.
3531
3532 This combines `defalias' and `make-obsolete'.
3533
3534 +++
3535 *** New function `unsafep' determines whether a Lisp form is safe.
3536
3537 It returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly do anything
3538 dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be unsafe
3539 (calls unknown function, alters global variable, etc).
3540
3541 +++
3542 *** New macro `eval-at-startup' specifies expressions to
3543 evaluate when Emacs starts up. If this is done after startup,
3544 it evaluates those expressions immediately.
3545
3546 This is useful in packages that can be preloaded.
3547
3548 *** `list-faces-display' takes an optional argument, REGEXP.
3549
3550 If it is non-nil, the function lists only faces matching this regexp.
3551
3552 ** Lisp code indentation features:
3553
3554 +++
3555 *** The `defmacro' form can contain indentation and edebug declarations.
3556
3557 These declarations specify how to indent the macro calls in Lisp mode
3558 and how to debug them with Edebug. You write them like this:
3559
3560 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3561
3562 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3563 possible declaration specifiers are:
3564
3565 (indent INDENT)
3566 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3567
3568 (edebug DEBUG)
3569 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3570 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro,
3571 but this is cleaner.)
3572
3573 ---
3574 *** cl-indent now allows customization of Indentation of backquoted forms.
3575
3576 See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3577
3578 ---
3579 *** cl-indent now handles indentation of simple and extended `loop' forms.
3580
3581 The new user options `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation',
3582 `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can
3583 be used to customize the indentation of keywords and forms in loop
3584 forms.
3585
3586 +++
3587 ** Variable aliases:
3588
3589 *** New function: defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3590
3591 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3592 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3593 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3594 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3595
3596 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3597 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3598
3599 *** New function: indirect-variable VARIABLE
3600
3601 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3602 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3603 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3604
3605 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3606 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3607
3608 +++
3609 *** The macro `define-obsolete-variable-alias' combines `defvaralias' and
3610 `make-obsolete-variable'.
3611
3612 ** defcustom changes:
3613
3614 +++
3615 *** The new customization type `float' requires a floating point number.
3616
3617 ** String changes:
3618
3619 +++
3620 *** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character.
3621
3622 Exception: In a character constant, if it is followed by a `-' in a
3623 character constant (e.g. ?\s-A), it is still interpreted as the super
3624 modifier. In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3625
3626 +++
3627 *** A hex escape in a string constant forces the string to be multibyte.
3628
3629 +++
3630 *** An octal escape in a string constant forces the string to be unibyte.
3631
3632 +++
3633 *** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3634 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3635 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3636 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3637 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3638
3639 +++
3640 *** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3641 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3642
3643 +++
3644 *** New function `substring-no-properties' returns a substring without
3645 text properties.
3646
3647 +++
3648 *** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
3649 `assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
3650 been declared obsolete.
3651
3652 +++
3653 ** Displaying warnings to the user.
3654
3655 See the functions `warn' and `display-warning', or the Lisp Manual.
3656 If you want to be sure the warning will not be overlooked, this
3657 facility is much better than using `message', since it displays
3658 warnings in a separate window.
3659
3660 +++
3661 ** Progress reporters.
3662
3663 These provide a simple and uniform way for commands to present
3664 progress messages for the user.
3665
3666 See the new functions `make-progress-reporter',
3667 `progress-reporter-update', `progress-reporter-force-update',
3668 `progress-reporter-done', and `dotimes-with-progress-reporter'.
3669
3670 ** Buffer positions:
3671
3672 +++
3673 *** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
3674 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
3675 the usable window height and width is used.
3676
3677 +++
3678 *** The `line-move', `scroll-up', and `scroll-down' functions will now
3679 modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
3680 taller that the height of the window, for example in the presence of
3681 large images. To disable this feature, bind the new variable
3682 `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
3683
3684 +++
3685 *** The argument to `forward-word', `backward-word' is optional.
3686
3687 It defaults to 1.
3688
3689 +++
3690 *** Argument to `forward-to-indentation' and `backward-to-indentation' is optional.
3691
3692 It defaults to 1.
3693
3694 +++
3695 *** New function `mouse-on-link-p' test if a position is in a clickable link.
3696
3697 This is the function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link'
3698 functionality.
3699
3700 +++
3701 *** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns the line number of a position.
3702
3703 It an optional buffer position argument that defaults to point.
3704
3705 +++
3706 *** `field-beginning' and `field-end' take new optional argument, LIMIT.
3707
3708 This argument tells them not to search beyond LIMIT. Instead they
3709 give up and return LIMIT.
3710
3711 +++
3712 *** Function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now returns the pixel coordinates
3713 and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
3714 arg is non-nil.
3715
3716 +++
3717 *** New functions `posn-at-point' and `posn-at-x-y' return
3718 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
3719 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
3720
3721 ** Text modification:
3722
3723 +++
3724 *** The new function `insert-for-yank' normally works like `insert', but
3725 removes the text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list
3726 and handles the `yank-handler' text property.
3727
3728 +++
3729 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-as-yank' is like
3730 `insert-for-yank' except that it gets the text from another buffer as
3731 in `insert-buffer-substring'.
3732
3733 +++
3734 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-no-properties' is like
3735 `insert-buffer-substring', but removes all text properties from the
3736 inserted substring.
3737
3738 +++
3739 *** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
3740 substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
3741 the filtered substring. Use it instead of `buffer-substring' or
3742 `delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
3743 data structure, such as the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register.
3744
3745 The list of filter function is specified by the new variable
3746 `buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode adds to
3747 `buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
3748 text.
3749
3750 +++
3751 *** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
3752 argument.
3753
3754 +++
3755 *** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3756 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3757 be inserted is translated through it.
3758
3759 ---
3760 *** Text clones.
3761
3762 The new function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3763 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3764 clone to the other.
3765
3766 ---
3767 *** The function `insert-string' is now obsolete.
3768
3769 ** Filling changes.
3770
3771 +++
3772 *** In determining an adaptive fill prefix, Emacs now tries the function in
3773 `adaptive-fill-function' _before_ matching the buffer line against
3774 `adaptive-fill-regexp' rather than _after_ it.
3775
3776 +++
3777 ** Atomic change groups.
3778
3779 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3780 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3781 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3782
3783 (atomic-change-group
3784 (insert foo)
3785 (delete-region x y))
3786
3787 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3788 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3789 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3790 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3791
3792 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3793 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3794
3795 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3796 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3797 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3798 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3799
3800 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3801 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3802 do this.
3803
3804 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3805 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3806 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3807 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3808
3809 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3810 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3811 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3812 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3813 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3814 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3815 twice.
3816
3817 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3818 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3819 returned values, like this:
3820
3821 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3822 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3823
3824 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3825 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3826 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3827
3828 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3829 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3830 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3831 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3832 finished.
3833
3834 ** Buffer-related changes:
3835
3836 ---
3837 *** `list-buffers-noselect' now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
3838
3839 If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
3840
3841 +++
3842 *** `kill-buffer-hook' is now a permanent local.
3843
3844 +++
3845 *** The new function `buffer-local-value' returns the buffer-local
3846 binding of VARIABLE (a symbol) in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not
3847 have a buffer-local binding in buffer BUFFER, it returns the default
3848 value of VARIABLE instead.
3849
3850 *** The function `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' now lets you maintain
3851 various status records in parallel.
3852
3853 It take a variable (a symbol) as argument. If the variable is non-nil,
3854 then its value should be a vector installed previously by
3855 `frame-or-buffer-changed-p'. If the frame names, buffer names, buffer
3856 order, or their read-only or modified flags have changed, since the
3857 time the vector's contents were recorded by a previous call to
3858 `frame-or-buffer-changed-p', then the function returns t. Otherwise
3859 it returns nil.
3860
3861 On the first call to `frame-or-buffer-changed-p', the variable's
3862 value should be nil. `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' stores a suitable
3863 vector into the variable and returns t.
3864
3865 If the variable is itself nil, then `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' uses,
3866 for compatibility, an internal variable which exists only for this
3867 purpose.
3868
3869 +++
3870 *** The function `read-buffer' follows the convention for reading from
3871 the minibuffer with a default value: if DEF is non-nil, the minibuffer
3872 prompt provided in PROMPT is edited to show the default value provided
3873 in DEF before the terminal colon and space.
3874
3875 ** Local variables lists:
3876
3877 +++
3878 *** Text properties in local variables.
3879
3880 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3881 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3882
3883 +++
3884 *** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3885 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3886 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3887 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3888 needed.
3889
3890 ---
3891 *** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3892 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3893 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3894 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3895 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3896 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3897
3898 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3899 confirmation as before.
3900
3901 ** Searching and matching changes:
3902
3903 +++
3904 *** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
3905 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
3906 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
3907
3908 +++
3909 *** The new variable `search-spaces-regexp' controls how to search
3910 for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
3911 regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
3912 expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
3913
3914 Spaces inside of constructs such as `[..]' and inside loops such as
3915 `*', `+', and `?' are never replaced with `search-spaces-regexp'.
3916
3917 +++
3918 *** New regular expression operators, `\_<' and `\_>'.
3919
3920 These match the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
3921 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
3922 specified by the syntax table.
3923
3924 ---
3925 *** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
3926
3927 +++
3928 *** `skip-chars-forward' and `skip-chars-backward' now handle
3929 character classes such as `[:alpha:]', along with individual
3930 characters and ranges.
3931
3932 ---
3933 *** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
3934 properties from surrounding text.
3935
3936 +++
3937 *** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
3938 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
3939 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
3940
3941 +++
3942 *** Functions `match-data' and `set-match-data' now have an optional
3943 argument `reseat'. When non-nil, all markers in the match data list
3944 passed to these function will be reseated to point to nowhere.
3945
3946 +++
3947 *** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
3948 variable `sentence-end-without-space', which contains such characters
3949 that end a sentence without following spaces.
3950
3951 The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of the
3952 variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil, then
3953 this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
3954 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
3955 `sentence-end-without-space'.
3956
3957 ** Undo changes:
3958
3959 +++
3960 *** `buffer-undo-list' can allows programmable elements.
3961
3962 These elements have the form (apply FUNNAME . ARGS), where FUNNAME is
3963 a symbol other than t or nil. That stands for a high-level change
3964 that should be undone by evaluating (apply FUNNAME ARGS).
3965
3966 These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
3967 which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
3968 range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
3969
3970 +++
3971 *** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
3972 `undo-outer-limit', garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
3973 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
3974
3975 +++
3976 ** New `yank-handler' text property can be used to control how
3977 previously killed text on the kill ring is reinserted.
3978
3979 The value of the `yank-handler' property must be a list with one to four
3980 elements with the following format:
3981 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
3982
3983 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3984 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3985 element on the kill-ring). If a `yank-handler' property is found,
3986 the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
3987
3988 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3989 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3990 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
3991 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
3992 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
3993 rectangle.
3994 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
3995 `yank-excluded-properties' is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
3996 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
3997 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
3998 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
3999 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
4000 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
4001 FUNCTION can set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
4002
4003 *** The functions `kill-new', `kill-append', and `kill-region' now have an
4004 optional argument to specify the `yank-handler' text property to put on
4005 the killed text.
4006
4007 *** The function `yank-pop' will now use a non-nil value of the variable
4008 `yank-undo-function' (instead of `delete-region') to undo the previous
4009 `yank' or `yank-pop' command (or a call to `insert-for-yank'). The function
4010 `insert-for-yank' automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
4011 element of the string argument's `yank-handler' text property if present.
4012
4013 *** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
4014 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
4015 string. The old behavior is available if you call
4016 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
4017
4018 ** Syntax table changes:
4019
4020 +++
4021 *** The macro `with-syntax-table' no longer copies the syntax table.
4022
4023 +++
4024 *** The new function `syntax-after' returns the syntax code
4025 of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
4026 of text properties as well as the character code.
4027
4028 +++
4029 *** `syntax-class' extracts the class of a syntax code (as returned
4030 by `syntax-after').
4031
4032 +++
4033 *** The new function `syntax-ppss' rovides an efficient way to find the
4034 current syntactic context at point.
4035
4036 ** File operation changes:
4037
4038 +++
4039 *** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
4040 searching for an executable or an Emacs Lisp file.
4041
4042 +++
4043 *** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
4044 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
4045 operation.
4046
4047 +++
4048 *** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
4049 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
4050 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
4051 The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
4052
4053 +++
4054 *** `buffer-auto-save-file-format' is the new name for what was
4055 formerly called `auto-save-file-format'. It is now a permanent local.
4056
4057 +++
4058 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
4059 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
4060 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
4061
4062 +++
4063 *** `copy-file' now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
4064
4065 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
4066
4067 +++
4068 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
4069 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
4070
4071 +++
4072 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
4073 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
4074 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
4075 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
4076
4077 +++
4078 *** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
4079 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
4080 tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
4081 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
4082
4083 +++
4084 *** If `buffer-save-without-query' is non-nil in some buffer,
4085 `save-some-buffers' will always save that buffer without asking (if
4086 it's modified).
4087
4088 +++
4089 *** New function `locate-file' searches for a file in a list of directories.
4090 `locate-file' accepts a name of a file to search (a string), and two
4091 lists: a list of directories to search in and a list of suffixes to
4092 try; typical usage might use `exec-path' and `load-path' for the list
4093 of directories, and `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' for the list
4094 of suffixes. The function also accepts a predicate argument to
4095 further filter candidate files.
4096
4097 One advantage of using this function is that the list of suffixes in
4098 `exec-suffixes' is OS-dependant, so this function will find
4099 executables without polluting Lisp code with OS dependancies.
4100
4101 ---
4102 *** The precedence of file name handlers has been changed.
4103
4104 Instead of choosing the first handler that matches,
4105 `find-file-name-handler' now gives precedence to a file name handler
4106 that matches nearest the end of the file name. More precisely, the
4107 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen. In case
4108 of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
4109
4110 +++
4111 *** A file name handler can declare which operations it handles.
4112
4113 You do this by putting an `operation' property on the handler name
4114 symbol. The property value should be a list of the operations that
4115 the handler really handles. It won't be called for any other
4116 operations.
4117
4118 This is useful for autoloaded handlers, to prevent them from being
4119 autoloaded when not really necessary.
4120
4121 +++
4122 *** The function `make-auto-save-file-name' is now handled by file
4123 name handlers. This will be exploited for remote files mainly.
4124
4125 ** Input changes:
4126
4127 +++
4128 *** An interactive specification can now use the code letter 'U' to get
4129 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
4130 previous `k' or `K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
4131
4132 +++
4133 *** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
4134 much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
4135 it returns just the directory name.
4136
4137 ---
4138 *** Functions `y-or-n-p', `read-char', `read-key-sequence' and the like, that
4139 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
4140 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
4141
4142 +++
4143 *** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
4144 arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
4145 quit had occurred. `while-no-input' returns the value of BODY, if BODY
4146 finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted by a quit, and t if
4147 BODY was aborted by arrival of input.
4148
4149 ** Minibuffer changes:
4150
4151 +++
4152 *** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional
4153 buffer argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted, it
4154 defaults to the current buffer.
4155
4156 +++
4157 *** New function `minibuffer-selected-window' returns the window which
4158 was selected when entering the minibuffer.
4159
4160 +++
4161 *** `read-from-minibuffer' now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
4162 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
4163
4164 +++
4165 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
4166 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
4167 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
4168 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
4169 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
4170
4171 ---
4172 *** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by Lisp code
4173 to override the built-in `read-file-name' function.
4174
4175 +++
4176 *** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
4177 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
4178 `read-file-name' function.
4179
4180 +++
4181 *** The new function `read-directory-name' for reading a directory name.
4182
4183 It is like `read-file-name' except that the defaulting works better
4184 for directories, and completion inside it shows only directories.
4185
4186 ** Completion changes:
4187
4188 +++
4189 *** The new function `minibuffer-completion-contents' returns the contents
4190 of the minibuffer just before point. That is what completion commands
4191 operate on.
4192
4193 +++
4194 *** The functions `all-completions' and `try-completion' now accept lists
4195 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
4196 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
4197 exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables can be either
4198 strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
4199
4200 +++
4201 *** The new macro `dynamic-completion-table' supports using functions
4202 as a dynamic completion table.
4203
4204 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
4205
4206 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
4207 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
4208 completions. This alist can be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
4209 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
4210 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
4211 entered. `dynamic-completion-table' then computes the completion.
4212
4213 +++
4214 *** The new macro `lazy-completion-table' initializes a variable
4215 as a lazy completion table.
4216
4217 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN)
4218
4219 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
4220 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with no
4221 arguments. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR.
4222 If completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
4223 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
4224 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
4225
4226 +++
4227 ** Enhancements to keymaps.
4228
4229 *** New keymaps for typing file names
4230
4231 Two new keymaps, `minibuffer-local-filename-completion-map' and
4232 `minibuffer-local-must-match-filename-map', apply whenever
4233 Emacs reads a file name in the minibuffer. These key maps override
4234 the usual binding of SPC to `minibuffer-complete-word' (so that file
4235 names with embedded spaces could be typed without the need to quote
4236 the spaces).
4237
4238 *** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
4239
4240 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
4241 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
4242 example,
4243
4244 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
4245
4246 *** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
4247
4248 This is an alternative to using `defadvice' or `substitute-key-definition'
4249 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
4250 binding and lookup functionality.
4251
4252 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
4253 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
4254 original command.
4255
4256 Example:
4257 Suppose that minor mode `my-mode' has defined the commands
4258 `my-kill-line' and `my-kill-word', and it wants C-k (and any other key
4259 bound to `kill-line') to run the command `my-kill-line' instead of
4260 `kill-line', and likewise it wants to run `my-kill-word' instead of
4261 `kill-word'.
4262
4263 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
4264 command remapping allows you to directly map `kill-line' into
4265 `my-kill-line' and `kill-word' into `my-kill-word' using `define-key':
4266
4267 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
4268 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
4269
4270 When `my-mode' is enabled, its minor mode keymap is enabled too. So
4271 when the user types C-k, that runs the command `my-kill-line'.
4272
4273 Only one level of remapping is supported. In the above example, this
4274 means that if `my-kill-line' is remapped to `other-kill', then C-k still
4275 runs `my-kill-line'.
4276
4277 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
4278
4279 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
4280 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
4281 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
4282 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
4283
4284 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
4285 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
4286
4287 - `key-binding' now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
4288 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
4289
4290 - `where-is-internal' now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
4291 `kill-line', when `my-mode' is enabled), and the actual key binding for
4292 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
4293 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
4294 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns "C-k" for `kill-line', and
4295 "<kill-line>" for `my-kill-line').
4296
4297 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
4298 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
4299 command was not remapped.
4300
4301 *** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
4302 over minor mode keymaps.
4303
4304 *** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
4305 text properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
4306 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
4307
4308 *** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
4309
4310 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
4311 bindings of the parent keymap.
4312
4313 *** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
4314
4315 *** New function `current-active-maps' returns a list of currently
4316 active keymaps.
4317
4318 *** New function `describe-buffer-bindings' inserts the list of all
4319 defined keys and their definitions.
4320
4321 *** New function `keymap-prompt' returns the prompt string of a keymap.
4322
4323 *** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
4324 in the keymap.
4325
4326 *** New variable `emulation-mode-map-alists'.
4327
4328 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
4329 keymap alist separate from `minor-mode-map-alist' by adding their
4330 keymap alist to this list.
4331
4332 ** Abbrev changes:
4333
4334 +++
4335 *** The new function `copy-abbrev-table' copies an abbrev table.
4336
4337 It returns a new abbrev table that is a copy of a given abbrev table.
4338
4339 +++
4340 *** `define-abbrev' now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG.
4341
4342 If non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means
4343 that it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the
4344 abbrevs. Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always
4345 specify this flag.
4346
4347 +++
4348 ** Enhancements to process support
4349
4350 *** Function `list-processes' now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
4351 it lists only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set.
4352
4353 *** New fns `set-process-query-on-exit-flag' and `process-query-on-exit-flag'.
4354
4355 These replace the old function `process-kill-without-query'. That
4356 function is still supported, but new code should use the new
4357 functions.
4358
4359 *** Function `signal-process' now accepts a process object or process
4360 name in addition to a process id to identify the signaled process.
4361
4362 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
4363 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
4364
4365 Use the new functions `process-get' and `process-put' to access, add,
4366 and modify elements on this property list. Use the new functions
4367 `process-plist' and `set-process-plist' to access and replace the
4368 entire property list of a process.
4369
4370 *** Function `accept-process-output' has a new optional fourth arg
4371 JUST-THIS-ONE. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
4372 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
4373 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
4374 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
4375 speech synthesis.
4376
4377 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
4378
4379 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
4380 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
4381 very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
4382 by setting the new variable `process-adaptive-read-buffering' to a
4383 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
4384 from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
4385 emacs tries to read it.
4386
4387 *** The new function `call-process-shell-command'.
4388
4389 This executes a shell command synchronously in a separate process.
4390
4391 *** The new function `process-file' is similar to `call-process', but
4392 obeys file handlers. The file handler is chosen based on
4393 `default-directory'.
4394
4395 *** A process filter function gets the output as multibyte string
4396 if the process specifies t for its filter's multibyteness.
4397
4398 That multibyteness is decided by the value of
4399 `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is created, and
4400 you can change it later with `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
4401
4402 *** The new function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the
4403 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4404
4405 *** The new function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns the
4406 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4407
4408 *** If a process's coding system is `raw-text' or `no-conversion' and its
4409 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
4410 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
4411 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
4412 which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
4413
4414 +++
4415 ** Enhanced networking support.
4416
4417 *** The new `make-network-process' function makes network connections.
4418 It allows opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
4419 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
4420
4421 - A server is started using :server t arg.
4422 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
4423 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
4424 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
4425 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
4426 - The process' property list can be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
4427 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
4428 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
4429
4430 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
4431 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
4432
4433 *** The old `open-network-stream' now uses `make-network-process'.
4434
4435 *** New functions `process-datagram-address', `set-process-datagram-address'.
4436
4437 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
4438 and set the current address of the remote partner.
4439
4440 *** New function `format-network-address'.
4441
4442 This function reformats the Lisp representation of a network address
4443 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
4444 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
4445 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
4446 string for other formatting options.
4447
4448 *** `process-contact' has an optional KEY argument.
4449
4450 Depending on this argument, you can get the complete list of network
4451 process properties or a specific property. Using :local or :remote as
4452 the KEY, you get the address of the local or remote end-point.
4453
4454 An Inet address is represented as a 5 element vector, where the first
4455 4 elements contain the IP address and the fifth is the port number.
4456
4457 *** New functions `stop-process' and `continue-process'.
4458
4459 These functions stop and restart communication through a network
4460 connection. For a server process, no connections are accepted in the
4461 stopped state. For a client process, no input is received in the
4462 stopped state.
4463
4464 *** New function `network-interface-list'.
4465
4466 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
4467 current network addresses.
4468
4469 *** New function `network-interface-info'.
4470
4471 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
4472 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
4473
4474 *** Deleting a network process with `delete-process' calls the sentinel.
4475
4476 The status message passed to the sentinel for a deleted network
4477 process is "deleted". The message passed to the sentinel when the
4478 connection is closed by the remote peer has been changed to
4479 "connection broken by remote peer".
4480
4481 ** Using window objects:
4482
4483 +++
4484 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4485
4486 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line or the
4487 header line.
4488
4489 +++
4490 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4491
4492 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line
4493 or the header line.
4494
4495 +++
4496 *** You can now make a window as short as one line.
4497
4498 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
4499 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
4500 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
4501 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
4502 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
4503
4504 +++
4505 *** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
4506 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
4507 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
4508 the mode line.
4509
4510 +++
4511 *** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
4512 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
4513
4514 +++
4515 *** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
4516 selected window without impacting the order of `buffer-list'.
4517 It saves and restores the current buffer, too.
4518
4519 +++
4520 *** `select-window' takes an optional second argument NORECORD.
4521
4522 This is like `switch-to-buffer'.
4523
4524 +++
4525 *** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
4526 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
4527 by calling `select-window'. It also saves and restores the current
4528 buffer.
4529
4530 +++
4531 *** `set-window-buffer' has an optional argument KEEP-MARGINS.
4532
4533 If non-nil, that says to preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
4534 and scroll-bar settings.
4535
4536 +++
4537 *** The new function `window-tree' returns a frame's window tree.
4538
4539 +++
4540 *** The functions `get-lru-window' and `get-largest-window' take an optional
4541 argument `dedicated'. If non-nil, those functions do not ignore
4542 dedicated windows.
4543
4544 +++
4545 *** The new function `adjust-window-trailing-edge' moves the right
4546 or bottom edge of a window. It does not move other window edges.
4547
4548 +++
4549 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
4550
4551 *** New function `define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
4552 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
4553
4554 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
4555 identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
4556
4557 *** New function `destroy-fringe-bitmap' deletes a fringe bitmap
4558 or restores a built-in one to its default value.
4559
4560 *** New function `set-fringe-bitmap-face' specifies the face to be
4561 used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is automatically merged
4562 with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face should only specify the
4563 foreground color of the bitmap.
4564
4565 *** There are new display properties, `left-fringe' and `right-fringe',
4566 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
4567 bitmap of the display line.
4568
4569 Format is `display (left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])', where BITMAP is a
4570 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
4571 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
4572 for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
4573 When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
4574
4575 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
4576 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
4577
4578 ** Other window fringe features:
4579
4580 +++
4581 *** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
4582
4583 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
4584 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
4585 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
4586 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
4587
4588 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
4589 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
4590 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
4591 between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
4592 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
4593 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
4594
4595 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
4596 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
4597 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
4598 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
4599
4600 +++
4601 *** Per-window fringe and scrollbar settings
4602
4603 **** Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and
4604 position settings.
4605
4606 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
4607 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
4608 `set-window-fringes'.
4609
4610 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
4611 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
4612 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
4613 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
4614
4615 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
4616 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
4617 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
4618 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
4619 an update of the display margins.
4620
4621 **** Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
4622 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
4623
4624 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
4625 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
4626 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
4627 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
4628 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
4629 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
4630 of the display margins.
4631
4632 ** Redisplay features:
4633
4634 +++
4635 *** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
4636
4637 +++
4638 *** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
4639 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
4640 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
4641 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
4642 forcing an explicit window update.
4643
4644 +++
4645 *** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
4646 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
4647 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
4648
4649 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
4650 does that, this value cannot be accurate.
4651
4652 +++
4653 *** You can define multiple overlay arrows via the new
4654 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'.
4655
4656 It contains a list of varibles which contain overlay arrow position
4657 markers, including the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
4658
4659 Each variable on this list can have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
4660 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
4661 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
4662 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
4663 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
4664 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
4665
4666 +++
4667 *** New `line-height' and `line-spacing' properties for newline characters
4668
4669 A newline can now have `line-height' and `line-spacing' text or overlay
4670 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
4671
4672 If the `line-height' property value is t, the newline does not
4673 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
4674 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a `line-spacing' property on this
4675 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
4676 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
4677
4678 If the `line-height' property value is a positive integer, the value
4679 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
4680 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
4681
4682 If the `line-height' property value is a float, the minimum line
4683 height is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by
4684 the given value.
4685
4686 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
4687 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
4688 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
4689
4690 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
4691 height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
4692
4693 If the `line-height' value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
4694 the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
4695 described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
4696 varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
4697 exactly that many pixels high.
4698
4699 If the `line-spacing' property value is an positive integer, the value
4700 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
4701 overrides the default frame `line-spacing' and any buffer local value of
4702 the `line-spacing' variable.
4703
4704 If the `line-spacing' property is a float or cons, the line spacing
4705 is calculated as specified above for the `line-height' property.
4706
4707 +++
4708 *** The buffer local `line-spacing' variable can now have a float value,
4709 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
4710
4711 +++
4712 *** Enhancements to stretch display properties
4713
4714 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
4715 PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
4716 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
4717
4718 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
4719 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
4720 are supported:
4721
4722 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
4723 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
4724 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
4725 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
4726 | scroll-bar | text
4727 POS ::= left | center | right
4728 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
4729 OP ::= + | -
4730
4731 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
4732 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
4733 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
4734 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
4735 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
4736 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
4737 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
4738 the image.
4739
4740 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
4741 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
4742 corresponding area of the window.
4743
4744 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
4745 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
4746 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
4747 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
4748 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
4749 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
4750 these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
4751 the width of the area.
4752
4753 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
4754 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
4755
4756 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
4757 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
4758 header line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
4759
4760 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
4761 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
4762 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
4763 height) of the specified image.
4764
4765 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
4766 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
4767
4768 +++
4769 *** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
4770 text property string that may be present at the current window
4771 position. The cursor can now be placed on any character of such
4772 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
4773
4774 +++
4775 *** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
4776 supported on text terminals.
4777
4778 +++
4779 *** Support for displaying image slices
4780
4781 **** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) can be used with
4782 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
4783
4784 **** Function `insert-image' has new optional fourth arg to
4785 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
4786
4787 **** New function `insert-sliced-image' inserts a given image as a
4788 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
4789
4790 +++
4791 *** Images can now have an associated image map via the :map property.
4792
4793 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
4794 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
4795 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((X0 . Y0) . (X1 . Y1))) specifying the
4796 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
4797 A circle is a cons (circle . ((X0 . Y0) . R)) specifying the center
4798 and the radius of the circle; R can be a float or integer.
4799 A polygon is a cons (poly . [X0 Y0 X1 Y1 ...]) where each pair in the
4800 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
4801
4802 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
4803 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
4804 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
4805 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
4806 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable `void-area-text-pointer'
4807 for possible pointer shapes.
4808
4809 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
4810 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
4811 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
4812
4813 +++
4814 *** The function `find-image' now searches in etc/images/ and etc/.
4815 The new variable `image-load-path' is a list of locations in which to
4816 search for image files. The default is to search in etc/images, then
4817 in etc/, and finally in the directories specified by `load-path'.
4818 Subdirectories of etc/ and etc/images are not recursively searched; if
4819 you put an image file in a subdirectory, you have to specify it
4820 explicitly; for example, if an image is put in etc/images/foo/bar.xpm:
4821
4822 (defimage foo-image '((:type xpm :file "foo/bar.xpm")))
4823
4824 +++
4825 *** The new variable `max-image-size' defines the maximum size of
4826 images that Emacs will load and display.
4827
4828 ** Mouse pointer features:
4829
4830 +++ (lispref)
4831 ??? (man)
4832 *** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
4833 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
4834 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
4835 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
4836 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
4837
4838 +++
4839 *** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
4840 :pointer image property.
4841
4842 +++
4843 *** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images can now be
4844 controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
4845
4846 ** Mouse event enhancements:
4847
4848 +++
4849 *** Mouse events for clicks on window fringes now specify `left-fringe'
4850 or `right-fringe' as the area.
4851
4852 +++
4853 *** All mouse events now include a buffer position regardless of where
4854 you clicked. For mouse clicks in window margins and fringes, this is
4855 a sensible buffer position corresponding to the surrounding text.
4856
4857 +++
4858 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
4859
4860 +++
4861 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
4862
4863 +++
4864 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
4865 text area).
4866
4867 +++
4868 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types
4869 and all areas.
4870
4871 +++
4872 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns the actual glyph coordinates
4873 of the mouse event position.
4874
4875 +++
4876 *** Mouse events can now indicate an image object clicked on.
4877
4878 +++
4879 *** Mouse events include relative X and Y pixel coordinates relative to
4880 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
4881
4882 +++
4883 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
4884 (image or character) clicked on.
4885
4886 +++
4887 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', 'posn-object-width-height'.
4888
4889 These return the image or string object of a mouse click, the X and Y
4890 pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner of that object, and
4891 the total width and height of that object.
4892
4893 ** Text property and overlay changes:
4894
4895 +++
4896 *** Arguments for `remove-overlays' are now optional, so that you can
4897 remove all overlays in the buffer with just (remove-overlays).
4898
4899 +++
4900 *** New variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4901
4902 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
4903 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
4904 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
4905 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
4906
4907 +++
4908 *** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
4909 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
4910 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
4911 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
4912 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
4913
4914 +++
4915 *** The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties'.
4916
4917 It is like `remove-text-properties' except that it takes a list of
4918 property names as argument rather than a property list.
4919
4920 ** Face changes
4921
4922 +++
4923 *** The new face attribute condition `min-colors' can be used to tailor
4924 the face color to the number of colors supported by a display, and
4925 define the foreground and background colors accordingly so that they
4926 look best on a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This
4927 is now the preferred method for defining default faces in a way that
4928 makes a good use of the capabilities of the display.
4929
4930 +++
4931 *** New function `display-supports-face-attributes-p' can be used to test
4932 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
4933
4934 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
4935 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
4936 defined with `defface'.
4937
4938 ---
4939 *** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
4940 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
4941 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
4942 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
4943 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
4944
4945 +++
4946 *** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
4947 `default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
4948 defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and can be overridden
4949 by them).
4950
4951 +++
4952 *** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
4953 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
4954 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
4955 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
4956 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
4957
4958 ---
4959 *** The function `face-differs-from-default-p' now truly checks
4960 whether the given face displays differently from the default face or
4961 not (previously it did only a very cursory check).
4962
4963 +++
4964 *** `face-attribute', `face-foreground', `face-background', `face-stipple'.
4965
4966 These now accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how
4967 face inheritance is used when determining the value of a face
4968 attribute.
4969
4970 +++
4971 *** New functions `face-attribute-relative-p' and `merge-face-attribute'
4972 help with handling relative face attributes.
4973
4974 +++
4975 *** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face list is reversed.
4976
4977 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
4978 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous
4979 releases of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made
4980 so that :inherit face lists operate identically to face lists in text
4981 `face' properties.
4982
4983 ---
4984 *** On terminals, faces with the :inverse-video attribute are displayed
4985 with swapped foreground and background colors even when one of them is
4986 not specified. In previous releases of Emacs, if either foreground
4987 or background color was unspecified, colors were not swapped. This
4988 was inconsistent with the face behavior under X.
4989
4990 ---
4991 *** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
4992 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
4993
4994 ** Font-Lock changes:
4995
4996 +++
4997 *** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
4998
4999 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
5000 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
5001 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
5002 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
5003
5004 +++
5005 *** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
5006
5007 **** the FACENAME returned in `font-lock-keywords' can be a list of the
5008 form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set other
5009 properties than `face'.
5010
5011 **** `font-lock-extra-managed-props' can be set to make sure those
5012 extra properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
5013
5014 ---
5015 *** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
5016
5017 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
5018 (see `jit-lock-defer-contextually'), then all of that text will
5019 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
5020 depends on text several lines further down (and when `font-lock-multiline'
5021 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
5022
5023 s{
5024 foo
5025 }{
5026 bar
5027 }e
5028
5029 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
5030 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a `jit-lock-defer-multiline'
5031 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
5032 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
5033
5034 ** Major mode mechanism changes:
5035
5036 +++
5037 *** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
5038 precedence over the file name. Likewise an `<?xml' or `<!DOCTYPE'
5039 declaration will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new
5040 var `magic-mode-alist'.
5041
5042 +++
5043 *** Use the new function `run-mode-hooks' to run the major mode's mode hook.
5044
5045 +++
5046 *** All major mode functions should now run the new normal hook
5047 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode
5048 hooks. `run-mode-hooks' does this automatically.
5049
5050 ---
5051 *** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
5052 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
5053 it in that buffer.
5054
5055 +++
5056 *** Major modes can define `eldoc-documentation-function'
5057 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
5058 the language.
5059
5060 +++
5061 *** `define-derived-mode' by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
5062 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
5063
5064 +++
5065 *** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
5066 are used by `define-derived-mode' to make sure the mode hook for the
5067 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
5068
5069 ** Minor mode changes:
5070
5071 +++
5072 *** `define-minor-mode' now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
5073 and simply passes them to `defcustom', if applicable.
5074
5075 +++
5076 *** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
5077
5078 +++
5079 *** `define-global-minor-mode'.
5080
5081 This is a new name for what was formerly called
5082 `easy-mmode-define-global-mode'. The old name remains as an alias.
5083
5084 ** Command loop changes:
5085
5086 +++
5087 *** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
5088 have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' to do: it returns t if the
5089 calling function was called through `call-interactively'.
5090
5091 Only use this when you cannot solve the problem by adding a new
5092 INTERACTIVE argument to the command.
5093
5094 +++
5095 *** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional argument.
5096
5097 If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks for a function that could be
5098 called with `call-interactively', and does not return t for keyboard
5099 macros.
5100
5101 +++
5102 *** When a command returns, the command loop moves point out from
5103 within invisible text, in the same way it moves out from within text
5104 covered by an image or composition property.
5105
5106 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
5107 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
5108 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
5109 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
5110 `post-command-hook' and thus does not care about intermediate states.
5111
5112 +++
5113 *** If a command sets `transient-mark-mode' to `only', that
5114 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
5115 During that following command, the value of `transient-mark-mode'
5116 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
5117 the next return to the command loop changes to nil.
5118
5119 +++
5120 *** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
5121 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
5122 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
5123
5124 +++
5125 *** `emacsserver' now runs `pre-command-hook' and `post-command-hook'
5126 when it receives a request from emacsclient.
5127
5128 ** Lisp file loading changes:
5129
5130 +++
5131 *** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
5132 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
5133 current file redefined it).
5134
5135 +++
5136 *** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
5137 defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
5138
5139 +++
5140 *** The function `symbol-file' can now search specifically for function,
5141 variable or face definitions.
5142
5143 +++
5144 *** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
5145 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
5146 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
5147
5148 ---
5149 *** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
5150 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
5151 than 3 levels of nesting.
5152
5153 +++
5154 ** Byte compiler changes:
5155
5156 *** The byte compiler now displays the actual line and character
5157 position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form of its
5158 warning and error messages have been brought into line with GNU standards
5159 for these. As a result, you can use next-error and friends on the
5160 compilation output buffer.
5161
5162 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
5163 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
5164
5165 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
5166 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
5167 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
5168 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
5169 forms:
5170
5171 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
5172 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
5173
5174 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
5175 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
5176 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
5177 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
5178 macro expansion), but such tests can be nested. Note that `when' and
5179 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
5180
5181 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
5182 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
5183 Emacs and XEmacs and can sometimes make the result significantly more
5184 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
5185 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
5186 you anything.
5187
5188 *** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in Lisp files is now obeyed.
5189
5190 ---
5191 *** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
5192 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
5193 (require 'cl) when loaded.
5194
5195 ** Frame operations:
5196
5197 +++
5198 *** New functions `frame-current-scroll-bars' and `window-current-scroll-bars'.
5199
5200 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
5201 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
5202
5203 +++
5204 *** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
5205 for all (existing and future) frames.
5206
5207 +++
5208 *** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
5209 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
5210 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
5211 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
5212
5213 +++
5214 *** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
5215 the `scroll-bar-width' frame parameter value is nil.
5216
5217 ** Mule changes:
5218
5219 +++
5220 *** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
5221
5222 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
5223 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
5224 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
5225 now:
5226
5227 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
5228
5229 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
5230 the time it takes to convert the format.
5231
5232 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
5233 wasteful.
5234
5235 ---
5236 *** `set-buffer-file-coding-system' now takes an additional argument,
5237 NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
5238
5239 +++
5240 *** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
5241 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
5242 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
5243 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
5244
5245 ---
5246 *** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
5247 of one coding system from another coding system.
5248
5249 ---
5250 *** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
5251 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
5252 parts, e.g. utf-16.
5253
5254 +++
5255 *** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
5256 it is read from a file without decoding.
5257
5258 ---
5259 *** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
5260 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
5261
5262 ---
5263 *** New function `quail-find-key' returns a list of keys to type in the
5264 current input method to input a character.
5265
5266 ** Mode line changes:
5267
5268 +++
5269 *** New function `format-mode-line'.
5270
5271 This returns the mode line or header line of the selected (or a
5272 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
5273
5274 +++
5275 *** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
5276 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
5277
5278 +++
5279 *** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
5280 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
5281 line.
5282
5283 +++
5284 *** Mouse-face on mode-line (and header-line) is now supported.
5285
5286 ** Menu manipulation changes:
5287
5288 ---
5289 *** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
5290 proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
5291 "files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
5292 several versions ago.
5293
5294 ---
5295 *** The dummy function keys made by easy-menu are now always lower case.
5296 If you specify the menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
5297 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
5298
5299 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for the bindings that were
5300 made with easy-menu.
5301
5302 ---
5303 *** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
5304 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
5305 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
5306 need to have a name.
5307
5308 ** Operating system access:
5309
5310 +++
5311 *** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
5312 run time used by Emacs since start-up.
5313
5314 +++
5315 *** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
5316 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
5317 accepts a float as UID parameter.
5318
5319 +++
5320 *** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
5321
5322 ---
5323 *** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
5324 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
5325 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
5326
5327 ---
5328 *** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
5329 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
5330
5331 ** Miscellaneous:
5332
5333 +++
5334 *** A number of hooks have been renamed to better follow the conventions:
5335
5336 `find-file-hooks' to `find-file-hook',
5337 `find-file-not-found-hooks' to `find-file-not-found-functions',
5338 `write-file-hooks' to `write-file-functions',
5339 `write-contents-hooks' to `write-contents-functions',
5340 `x-lost-selection-hooks' to `x-lost-selection-functions',
5341 `x-sent-selection-hooks' to `x-sent-selection-functions',
5342 `delete-frame-hook' to `delete-frame-functions'.
5343
5344 In each case the old name remains as an alias for the moment.
5345
5346 +++
5347 *** local-write-file-hooks is marked obsolete
5348
5349 Use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook'.
5350
5351 ---
5352 *** New function `x-send-client-message' sends a client message when
5353 running under X.
5354
5355 ** GC changes:
5356
5357 +++
5358 *** New variable `gc-cons-percentage' automatically grows the GC cons threshold
5359 as the heap size increases.
5360
5361 +++
5362 *** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
5363 on garbage collection.
5364
5365 +++
5366 *** The normal hook `post-gc-hook' is run at the end of garbage collection.
5367
5368 The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
5369 \f
5370 * New Packages for Lisp Programming in Emacs 22.1
5371
5372 +++
5373 ** The new library button.el implements simple and fast `clickable
5374 buttons' in emacs buffers. Buttons are much lighter-weight than the
5375 `widgets' implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that
5376 doesn't require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for
5377 such things as help and apropos buffers.
5378
5379 ---
5380 ** The new library tree-widget.el provides a widget to display a set
5381 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
5382 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
5383
5384 +++
5385 ** The new library bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
5386 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
5387 data structures.
5388
5389 ---
5390 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
5391 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
5392
5393 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
5394 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
5395 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
5396 commands.
5397
5398 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
5399 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
5400 SQL buffer.
5401
5402 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
5403 (function (lambda ()
5404 (master-mode t)
5405 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5406 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
5407 (function (lambda ()
5408 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5409
5410 +++
5411 ** The new library benchmark.el does timing measurements on Lisp code.
5412
5413 This includes measuring garbage collection time.
5414
5415 +++
5416 ** The new library testcover.el does test coverage checking.
5417
5418 This is so you can tell whether you've tested all paths in your Lisp
5419 code. It works with edebug.
5420
5421 The function `testcover-start' instruments all functions in a given
5422 file. Then test your code. The function `testcover-mark-all' adds
5423 overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to show where coverage
5424 is lacking. The command `testcover-next-mark' (bind it to a key!)
5425 will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
5426
5427 Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely
5428 evaluated; a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same
5429 value. The red splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly
5430 complete their evaluation, such as `error'. The brown splotches are
5431 skipped for forms that are expected to always evaluate to the same
5432 value, such as (setq x 14).
5433
5434 For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to
5435 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a
5436 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does
5437 return. The macro `1value' suppresses a brown splotch for its argument.
5438 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals
5439 an error if the argument actually returns differing values.
5440 \f
5441 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
5442
5443 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
5444 been added.
5445
5446 \f
5447 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
5448
5449 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
5450 with Custom.
5451
5452 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
5453 as mule-utf-8.
5454
5455 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
5456 in UTF-8 locales).
5457
5458 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
5459 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
5460 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
5461 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
5462 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
5463 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
5464 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
5465 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
5466 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
5467 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
5468
5469 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
5470 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
5471
5472 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
5473 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
5474 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
5475 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
5476 contrary to the compound text specification.
5477
5478 \f
5479 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
5480
5481 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
5482
5483 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
5484
5485 \f
5486 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
5487
5488 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
5489
5490 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
5491 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
5492 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
5493 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
5494 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
5495
5496 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
5497 were changed.
5498
5499 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
5500 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
5501
5502 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
5503 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
5504 instead of using default-major-mode.
5505
5506 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
5507 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
5508 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
5509 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
5510 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
5511 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
5512 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
5513
5514 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
5515 NEWS.
5516
5517 \f
5518 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
5519
5520 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
5521 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
5522 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
5523
5524 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
5525 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
5526
5527 \f
5528 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
5529
5530 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
5531 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
5532 charsets in this release.
5533
5534 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
5535
5536 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
5537
5538 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
5539 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
5540 to list them.
5541
5542 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
5543 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
5544 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
5545 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
5546 necessary changes to unexec.
5547
5548 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
5549 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
5550
5551 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
5552 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
5553
5554 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
5555 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
5556
5557 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
5558 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
5559 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
5560 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
5561 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
5562
5563 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
5564 new display features described below.
5565
5566 \f
5567 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
5568
5569 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
5570
5571 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
5572 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
5573 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
5574 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
5575 the text.
5576
5577 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
5578
5579 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
5580 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
5581 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
5582 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
5583 specify a font.
5584
5585 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
5586 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
5587 under Lisp changes, below.
5588
5589 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
5590
5591 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
5592 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
5593 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
5594 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
5595 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
5596 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
5597 on terminals.
5598
5599 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
5600 supported on character terminals.
5601
5602 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
5603 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
5604 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
5605 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
5606
5607 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
5608
5609 ** Sound support
5610
5611 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
5612 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
5613 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
5614 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
5615 sound support.
5616
5617 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
5618
5619 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
5620 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
5621 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
5622 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
5623
5624 - User option: max-mini-window-height
5625
5626 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
5627 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
5628 specifies a number of lines.
5629
5630 Default is 0.25.
5631
5632 - User option: resize-mini-windows
5633
5634 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
5635 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
5636 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
5637 again.
5638
5639 Default is `grow-only'.
5640
5641 ** LessTif support.
5642
5643 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
5644 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
5645
5646 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
5647
5648 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
5649 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
5650 non-nil.
5651
5652 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
5653
5654 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
5655 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
5656 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
5657
5658 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
5659
5660 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
5661 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
5662 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
5663 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
5664 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
5665 Emacs.
5666
5667 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
5668 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
5669 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
5670 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
5671 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
5672 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
5673
5674 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
5675 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
5676 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
5677 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
5678 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
5679 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
5680
5681 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
5682 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
5683 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
5684 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
5685 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
5686
5687 ** Tool bar support.
5688
5689 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
5690 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
5691 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
5692 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
5693 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
5694 icons will be used.
5695
5696 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
5697 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
5698
5699 ** Tooltips.
5700
5701 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
5702 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
5703 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
5704
5705 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
5706 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
5707 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
5708 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
5709
5710 ** Automatic Hscrolling
5711
5712 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
5713 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
5714 customized.
5715
5716 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
5717 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
5718 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
5719 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
5720 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
5721
5722 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
5723 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
5724 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
5725 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
5726 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
5727 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
5728
5729 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
5730 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
5731 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
5732 customizing face `fringe'.
5733
5734 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
5735 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
5736 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
5737 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
5738 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
5739 the window to be partially obscured.)
5740
5741 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
5742 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
5743 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
5744 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
5745
5746 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
5747
5748 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
5749 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
5750 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
5751 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
5752 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
5753 have enabled one.
5754
5755 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
5756
5757 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
5758
5759 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
5760
5761 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
5762 `*') toggles the status.
5763
5764 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
5765
5766 ** Hourglass pointer
5767
5768 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
5769 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
5770
5771 ** Blinking cursor
5772
5773 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
5774 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
5775 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
5776 the group `cursor'.
5777
5778 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
5779
5780 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
5781 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
5782 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
5783 details.
5784
5785 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
5786 have to do anything to activate it.
5787
5788 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
5789
5790 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
5791 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
5792
5793 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
5794 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
5795 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
5796 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
5797 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
5798 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
5799 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
5800 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
5801
5802 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
5803 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
5804 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
5805 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
5806 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
5807 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
5808
5809 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
5810 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
5811
5812 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
5813 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
5814 buffer by default.
5815
5816 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
5817 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
5818 beginning and end of the buffer.
5819
5820 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
5821 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
5822 signaled.
5823
5824 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
5825 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
5826
5827 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
5828 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
5829 this behavior.
5830
5831 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
5832 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
5833 Emacs dump core.
5834
5835 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
5836
5837 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
5838 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
5839 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
5840
5841 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
5842 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
5843 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
5844
5845 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
5846 using that menu.
5847
5848 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
5849
5850 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
5851 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
5852 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
5853 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
5854 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
5855 whitespace.
5856
5857 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
5858 all frames except the selected one.
5859
5860 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
5861 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
5862
5863 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
5864 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
5865 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
5866 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
5867 `Info-use-header-line'.
5868
5869 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
5870 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
5871 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
5872
5873 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
5874
5875 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
5876 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
5877 `fr-drdref.tex'.
5878
5879 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
5880 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
5881 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
5882 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
5883
5884 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
5885
5886 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
5887 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
5888 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
5889 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
5890
5891 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
5892 point in a pop-up window.
5893
5894 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
5895 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
5896 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
5897
5898 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
5899 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
5900
5901 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
5902 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
5903 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
5904 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
5905
5906 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
5907
5908 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
5909 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
5910
5911 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
5912 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
5913 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
5914
5915 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
5916 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
5917 non-nil.
5918
5919 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
5920 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
5921 file that is already visited under a different name.
5922
5923 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
5924 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
5925
5926 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
5927 and displays information about that.
5928
5929 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
5930 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
5931
5932 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
5933 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
5934 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
5935 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
5936 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
5937 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
5938
5939 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
5940 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
5941
5942 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
5943 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
5944 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
5945 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
5946 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
5947 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
5948 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
5949
5950 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
5951 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
5952
5953 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
5954 system for keyboard input.
5955
5956 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
5957 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
5958 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
5959 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
5960 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
5961 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
5962 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
5963 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
5964 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
5965
5966 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
5967 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
5968
5969 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
5970 displays all characters in that character set.
5971
5972 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
5973 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
5974
5975 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
5976 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
5977 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
5978
5979 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
5980 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
5981 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
5982 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
5983 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
5984 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
5985 and Polish `slash'.
5986
5987 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
5988 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
5989 of the tutorial.
5990
5991 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
5992 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
5993 Lisp Coding Convention".
5994
5995 new command old-binding
5996 --- ------- -----------
5997 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
5998 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
5999 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
6000
6001 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
6002 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
6003 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
6004
6005 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
6006 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
6007 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
6008 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
6009 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
6010 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
6011
6012 ** There are new Leim input methods.
6013 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
6014 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
6015 package.
6016
6017 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
6018 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
6019 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
6020 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
6021 "`", you must type "=q".
6022
6023 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
6024 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
6025 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
6026 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
6027 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
6028 on.
6029
6030 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
6031 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
6032 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
6033 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
6034
6035 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
6036 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
6037 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
6038 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
6039
6040 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
6041 on the display using several methods
6042
6043 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
6044 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
6045 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
6046
6047 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
6048 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
6049
6050 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
6051
6052 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
6053 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
6054
6055 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
6056 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
6057 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
6058 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
6059
6060 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
6061 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
6062 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
6063
6064 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
6065 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
6066
6067 ** New X resources recognized
6068
6069 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
6070 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
6071 is useful for debugging X problems.
6072
6073 Example:
6074
6075 emacs.synchronous: true
6076
6077 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
6078 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
6079 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
6080 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
6081 visual class names are
6082
6083 TrueColor
6084 PseudoColor
6085 DirectColor
6086 StaticColor
6087 GrayScale
6088 StaticGray
6089
6090 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
6091 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
6092 meaning.
6093
6094 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
6095 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
6096 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
6097 visual.
6098
6099 Example:
6100
6101 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
6102
6103 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
6104 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
6105 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
6106 resource values are `true' or `on'.
6107
6108 Example:
6109
6110 emacs.privateColormap: true
6111
6112 ** Faces and frame parameters.
6113
6114 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
6115 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
6116 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
6117 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
6118 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
6119 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
6120 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
6121
6122 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
6123 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
6124 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
6125 `default' face and vice versa.
6126
6127 ** New face `menu'.
6128
6129 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
6130
6131 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
6132
6133 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
6134 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
6135 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
6136 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
6137
6138 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
6139 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
6140 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
6141
6142 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
6143 `ScreenGamma'.
6144
6145 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
6146
6147 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
6148 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
6149 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
6150 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
6151
6152 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
6153
6154 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
6155
6156 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
6157
6158 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
6159 LessTif/Motif one.
6160
6161 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
6162 LessTif and Motif.
6163
6164 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
6165
6166 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
6167 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
6168 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
6169
6170 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
6171 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
6172
6173 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
6174 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
6175 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
6176
6177 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
6178
6179 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
6180 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
6181 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
6182 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
6183
6184 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
6185 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
6186 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
6187 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
6188
6189 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
6190 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
6191 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
6192 buffers.
6193
6194 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
6195
6196 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
6197 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
6198 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
6199
6200 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
6201 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
6202 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
6203 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
6204 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
6205 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
6206
6207 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
6208
6209 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
6210 notably at the end of lines.
6211
6212 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
6213 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
6214
6215 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
6216
6217 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
6218 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
6219
6220 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
6221 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
6222 after each match to get the replacement text.
6223
6224 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
6225 you edit the replacement string.
6226
6227 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
6228 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
6229 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
6230
6231 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
6232
6233 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
6234 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
6235
6236 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
6237 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
6238 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
6239 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
6240
6241 --
6242 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
6243 read mail from the menu etc.
6244
6245 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
6246 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
6247 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
6248 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
6249
6250 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
6251 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6252
6253 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
6254 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
6255 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
6256 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
6257 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
6258 of Emacs.
6259
6260 ** Customize changes
6261
6262 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
6263 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
6264 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
6265 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
6266 earlier versions of Emacs.
6267
6268 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
6269 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
6270 default).
6271
6272 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
6273 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
6274 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
6275 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
6276 file.
6277
6278 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
6279 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
6280 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
6281 already in your init file.
6282
6283 ** New features in evaluation commands
6284
6285 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
6286 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
6287 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
6288 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
6289 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
6290
6291 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
6292 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
6293 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
6294 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
6295 printed).
6296
6297 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
6298 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
6299
6300 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
6301 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
6302
6303 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
6304 code when called with a prefix argument.
6305
6306 ** CC mode changes.
6307
6308 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
6309 current user setups (although it's believed that these
6310 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
6311 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
6312 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
6313 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
6314 release.
6315
6316 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
6317 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
6318 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
6319 confusion.
6320
6321 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
6322 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
6323 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
6324 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
6325
6326 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
6327 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
6328
6329 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
6330 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
6331
6332 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
6333 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
6334 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
6335 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
6336
6337 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
6338 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
6339 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
6340 earlier statement. An example:
6341
6342 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
6343 if (a[i])
6344 res += a[i]->offset;
6345 else
6346
6347 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
6348 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
6349 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
6350 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
6351 the preceding "if".
6352
6353 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
6354 by default.
6355
6356 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
6357 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
6358 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
6359 documentation or other natural language text.
6360
6361 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
6362 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
6363 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
6364 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
6365 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
6366 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
6367 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
6368
6369 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
6370 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
6371 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
6372 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
6373
6374 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
6375 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
6376 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
6377 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
6378 Pike mode only.
6379
6380 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
6381 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
6382 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
6383 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
6384 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
6385 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
6386 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
6387 is reported afterwards.
6388
6389 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
6390 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
6391 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
6392
6393 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
6394 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
6395 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
6396 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
6397 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
6398 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
6399 groundwork.
6400
6401 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
6402 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
6403 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
6404 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
6405 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
6406 have to bother.
6407
6408 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
6409 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
6410 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
6411 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
6412 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
6413 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
6414
6415 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
6416 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
6417 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
6418 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
6419 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
6420 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
6421 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
6422 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
6423
6424 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
6425 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
6426 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
6427 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
6428 above.
6429
6430 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
6431 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
6432 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
6433 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
6434 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
6435 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
6436 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
6437 function documentation for more info.
6438
6439 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
6440 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
6441 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
6442 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
6443 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
6444 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
6445 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
6446 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
6447
6448 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
6449
6450 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
6451 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
6452
6453 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
6454 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
6455 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
6456 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
6457 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
6458 style system.
6459
6460 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
6461 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
6462 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
6463 as far as possible.
6464
6465 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
6466 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
6467 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
6468 chapter about this in the manual.
6469
6470 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
6471 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
6472 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
6473 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
6474 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
6475
6476 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
6477 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
6478 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
6479
6480 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
6481 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
6482
6483 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
6484 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
6485 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
6486 inside CC Mode.
6487
6488 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
6489 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
6490 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
6491 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
6492 cc-mode/).
6493
6494 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
6495 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
6496 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
6497 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
6498 they were before the filling.
6499
6500 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
6501 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
6502 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
6503 literals.
6504
6505 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
6506 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
6507 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
6508 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
6509 this function.
6510
6511 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
6512 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
6513 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
6514 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
6515 Thanks to Eric Eide.
6516
6517 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
6518 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
6519 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
6520
6521 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
6522
6523 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
6524 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
6525 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
6526 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
6527
6528 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
6529 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
6530 the column specified by comment-column.
6531
6532 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
6533 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
6534 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
6535 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
6536 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
6537 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
6538
6539 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
6540 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
6541 arguments.
6542
6543 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
6544
6545 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
6546 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
6547 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
6548 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
6549 Provan).
6550
6551 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
6552
6553 ** Dired changes
6554
6555 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
6556 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
6557 is, delete only empty directories.
6558
6559 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
6560 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
6561 copy directories recursively.
6562
6563 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
6564 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
6565 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
6566
6567 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
6568 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
6569 directory.
6570
6571 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
6572 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
6573 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
6574 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
6575 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
6576
6577 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
6578 from ls switches.
6579
6580 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
6581 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
6582 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
6583 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
6584
6585 ** Gnus changes.
6586
6587 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
6588 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
6589 internationalization and mail-fetching.
6590
6591 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
6592 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
6593
6594 If you used procmail like in
6595
6596 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
6597 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
6598 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
6599 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
6600
6601 this now has changed to
6602
6603 (setq mail-sources
6604 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
6605 :suffix ".in")))
6606
6607 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
6608 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
6609
6610 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
6611 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
6612 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
6613 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
6614
6615 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
6616 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
6617 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
6618
6619 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
6620 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
6621 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
6622 now just a compatibility layer.
6623
6624 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
6625 Gnus facilities.
6626
6627 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
6628 called to position point.
6629
6630 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
6631 summary buffers and NOV files.
6632
6633 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
6634 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
6635
6636 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
6637 subtly different manner.
6638
6639 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
6640 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
6641 ever-changing layouts.
6642
6643 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
6644
6645 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
6646
6647 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
6648
6649 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
6650 macros
6651
6652 Key binding Macro
6653 -------------------------
6654 C-c C-c C-s @strong
6655 C-c C-c C-e @emph
6656 C-c C-c u @uref
6657 C-c C-c q @quotation
6658 C-c C-c m @email
6659 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
6660 M-RET @item
6661
6662 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
6663
6664 ** Changes in Outline mode.
6665
6666 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
6667 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
6668 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
6669
6670 ** Changes to Emacs Server
6671
6672 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
6673 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
6674 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
6675 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
6676 buffers to kill, as before.
6677
6678 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
6679 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
6680 this way.
6681
6682 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
6683 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
6684
6685 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
6686
6687 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
6688 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
6689 use. Default is 1000.
6690
6691 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
6692 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
6693
6694 ** Changes to hideshow.el
6695
6696 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
6697
6698 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
6699 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
6700 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
6701 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
6702
6703 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
6704 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
6705 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
6706 the open block.
6707
6708 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
6709 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
6710 the normal block-hiding function.
6711
6712 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
6713
6714 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
6715 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
6716 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
6717 for `hs-minor-mode'.
6718
6719 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
6720 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
6721
6722 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
6723
6724 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
6725 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
6726 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
6727
6728 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
6729 current buffer.
6730
6731 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
6732 in a log file.
6733
6734 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
6735 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
6736 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
6737 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
6738 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
6739 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
6740
6741 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
6742
6743 ** Changes to cmuscheme
6744
6745 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
6746 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
6747
6748 ** Changes in Font Lock
6749
6750 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
6751 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
6752
6753 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
6754 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
6755
6756 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
6757 the face used for each string/comment.
6758
6759 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
6760 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
6761
6762 ** Changes to Shell mode
6763
6764 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
6765 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
6766 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
6767 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
6768
6769 ** Comint (subshell) changes
6770
6771 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
6772 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
6773
6774 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
6775 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
6776 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
6777 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
6778 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
6779 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
6780
6781 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
6782 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
6783 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
6784 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
6785 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
6786 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
6787 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
6788 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
6789
6790 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
6791 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
6792
6793 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
6794 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
6795 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
6796
6797 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
6798 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
6799 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
6800
6801 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
6802 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
6803 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
6804
6805 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
6806 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
6807 argument, it appends to the file.
6808
6809 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
6810 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
6811 compatibility.
6812
6813 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
6814 ring (history).
6815
6816 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
6817 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
6818 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
6819
6820 ** Changes to Rmail mode
6821
6822 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
6823 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
6824 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
6825 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
6826 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
6827 as correspondent.
6828
6829 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
6830 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
6831 regexp matching your mail addresses.
6832
6833 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
6834 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
6835 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
6836 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
6837 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
6838
6839 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
6840 like `j'.
6841
6842 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
6843 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
6844 digest message.
6845
6846 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
6847 in which folder to put messages automatically.
6848
6849 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
6850 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
6851 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
6852
6853 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
6854 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
6855
6856 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
6857 use the -f option when sending mail.
6858
6859 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
6860 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
6861 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
6862 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
6863 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
6864 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
6865
6866 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
6867 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
6868 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
6869
6870 ** Changes to TeX mode
6871
6872 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
6873 `latex-mode'.
6874
6875 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
6876
6877 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
6878
6879 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
6880
6881 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
6882
6883 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
6884 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
6885 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
6886 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
6887 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
6888 can be edited from that buffer.
6889
6890 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
6891 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
6892 `A' to use all marked entries).
6893
6894 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
6895 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
6896
6897 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
6898 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
6899 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
6900 been cited.
6901
6902 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
6903 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
6904 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
6905 in column 1 are always made leaves.
6906
6907 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
6908 has the following new features:
6909
6910 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
6911 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
6912 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
6913 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
6914
6915 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
6916 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
6917 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
6918 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
6919 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
6920 defaults to 1.
6921
6922 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
6923 file names.
6924
6925 ** Ispell changes
6926
6927 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
6928 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
6929 spell-checks the current buffer.
6930
6931 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
6932 added.
6933
6934 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
6935 correction is made and re-checked.
6936
6937 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
6938
6939 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
6940 cases.
6941
6942 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
6943 on syntax errors.
6944
6945 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
6946 end of the buffer.
6947
6948 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6949
6950 ** Makefile mode changes
6951
6952 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
6953
6954 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
6955 Fontlock mode is active.
6956
6957 ** Isearch changes
6958
6959 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
6960 so that searches can be resumed.
6961
6962 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
6963 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
6964 that started the search.
6965
6966 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
6967 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
6968
6969 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
6970
6971 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
6972 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
6973 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
6974 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
6975 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
6976 `secondary-selection'.
6977
6978 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
6979 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
6980 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
6981 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
6982 usual snappy response.
6983
6984 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
6985 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
6986 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
6987 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
6988
6989 ** VC Changes
6990
6991 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
6992 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
6993 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
6994 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
6995 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
6996 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
6997 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
6998 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
6999 file is registered in that backend.
7000
7001 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
7002 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
7003 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
7004 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
7005 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
7006 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
7007
7008 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
7009 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
7010 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
7011 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
7012 where it doesn't make sense.)
7013
7014 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
7015 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
7016 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
7017
7018 *** General Changes
7019
7020 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
7021 checks are always done now.
7022
7023 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
7024 operations.
7025
7026 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
7027 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
7028 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
7029
7030 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
7031 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
7032 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
7033 the working file (``merge news'').
7034
7035 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
7036 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
7037 downwards.
7038
7039 *** Multiple Backends
7040
7041 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
7042 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
7043 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
7044 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
7045 local RCS archives.
7046
7047 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
7048 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
7049 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
7050 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
7051
7052 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
7053 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
7054 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
7055 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
7056 current revision number from the more remote backend.
7057
7058 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
7059 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
7060 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
7061 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
7062
7063 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
7064 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
7065 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
7066 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
7067
7068 *** Changes for CVS
7069
7070 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
7071 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
7072 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
7073 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
7074 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
7075 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
7076 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
7077
7078 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
7079 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
7080 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
7081 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
7082 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
7083 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
7084 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
7085 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
7086 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
7087 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
7088 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
7089 name.)
7090
7091 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
7092 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
7093 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
7094 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
7095 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
7096 entire directory tree.
7097
7098 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
7099 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
7100 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
7101 "watched" by other developers.)
7102
7103 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
7104 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
7105 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
7106 starting at the given directory.
7107
7108 *** Lisp Changes in VC
7109
7110 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
7111 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
7112 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
7113 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
7114 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
7115 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
7116 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
7117 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
7118 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
7119
7120 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
7121 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
7122 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
7123 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
7124
7125 ** New modes and packages
7126
7127 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
7128 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
7129 the default is not applicable.
7130
7131 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
7132 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
7133 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
7134
7135 Features are:
7136
7137 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
7138 drawn, like this: | \ /
7139 --+-- X
7140 | / \
7141
7142 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
7143 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
7144 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
7145 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
7146 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
7147 you are drawing.
7148
7149 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
7150 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
7151
7152 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
7153 flood-filling.
7154
7155 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
7156 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
7157 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
7158 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
7159
7160 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
7161 also do without the mouse.
7162
7163 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
7164 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
7165 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
7166 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
7167 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
7168
7169 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
7170
7171 lines straight-lines
7172 rectangles squares
7173 poly-lines straight poly-lines
7174 ellipses circles
7175 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
7176 spray-can setting size for spraying
7177 vaporize line vaporize lines
7178 erase characters erase rectangles
7179
7180 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
7181 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
7182 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
7183 drawing.
7184
7185 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
7186 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
7187 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
7188 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
7189
7190 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
7191 can be turned off).
7192
7193 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
7194 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
7195 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
7196 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
7197 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
7198 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
7199 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
7200 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
7201 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
7202
7203 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
7204 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
7205 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
7206 on certain projects.
7207
7208 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
7209 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
7210
7211 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
7212
7213 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
7214 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
7215 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
7216 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
7217 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
7218 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
7219 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
7220 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
7221
7222 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
7223 Emacs is idle.
7224
7225 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
7226 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
7227
7228 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
7229 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
7230
7231 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
7232 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
7233 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
7234 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
7235 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
7236
7237 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
7238 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
7239 separate Texinfo file.
7240
7241 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
7242 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
7243 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
7244 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
7245 enter check-in log messages.
7246
7247 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
7248 without invoking external programs.
7249
7250 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
7251 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
7252 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
7253 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
7254 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
7255
7256 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
7257 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
7258
7259 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
7260 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
7261
7262 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
7263 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
7264 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
7265 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
7266 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
7267 single step.
7268
7269 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
7270 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
7271 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
7272 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
7273
7274 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
7275 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
7276 actually modifying content of a buffer.
7277
7278 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
7279 PostScript.
7280
7281 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
7282
7283 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
7284
7285 ; comment (until end of line)
7286 A non-terminal
7287 "C" terminal
7288 ?C? special
7289 $A default non-terminal
7290 $"C" default terminal
7291 $?C? default special
7292 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
7293 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
7294 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
7295 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
7296 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
7297 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
7298 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
7299 C+ one or more occurrences of C
7300 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
7301 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
7302 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
7303 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
7304 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
7305 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
7306 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
7307
7308 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
7309
7310 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
7311 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
7312 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
7313 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
7314 equal signs of assignments.
7315
7316 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
7317 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
7318
7319 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
7320 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
7321 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
7322
7323 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
7324
7325 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
7326 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
7327 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
7328 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
7329 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
7330 which answers different needs.
7331
7332 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
7333 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
7334 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
7335 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
7336 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
7337 to be enabled.
7338
7339 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
7340 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
7341
7342 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
7343
7344 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
7345 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
7346 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
7347
7348 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
7349
7350 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
7351 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
7352 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
7353 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
7354 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
7355 and background colors.
7356
7357 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
7358 Pascal) language.
7359
7360 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
7361 the text at point.
7362
7363 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
7364
7365 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
7366
7367 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
7368 whitespace in a file.
7369
7370 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
7371 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
7372 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
7373 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
7374 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
7375 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
7376 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
7377
7378 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
7379
7380 Here is an example of columns:
7381
7382 horse apple bus
7383 dog pineapple car EXTRA
7384 porcupine strawberry airplane
7385
7386 Doing the following settings:
7387
7388 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
7389 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
7390 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
7391 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
7392
7393
7394 Selecting the lines above and typing:
7395
7396 M-x delimit-columns-region
7397
7398 It results:
7399
7400 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
7401 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
7402 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
7403
7404 delim-col has the following options:
7405
7406 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
7407 before all columns.
7408
7409 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
7410 between each column.
7411
7412 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
7413 after all columns.
7414
7415 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
7416 each column.
7417
7418 delim-col has the following commands:
7419
7420 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
7421 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
7422
7423 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
7424 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
7425 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
7426 recent file list can be displayed:
7427
7428 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
7429 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
7430 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
7431
7432 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
7433 dynamically change the menu appearance.
7434
7435 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
7436 text.
7437
7438 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
7439 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
7440 specific to Message mode.
7441
7442 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
7443 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
7444 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
7445
7446 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
7447 interface to access directory servers using different directory
7448 protocols. It has a separate manual.
7449
7450 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
7451 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
7452
7453 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
7454
7455 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
7456 minibuffer with completion.
7457
7458 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
7459 with the diary features.
7460
7461 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
7462 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
7463
7464 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
7465 Fill mode.
7466
7467 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
7468 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
7469 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
7470 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
7471
7472 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
7473 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
7474 `.g'.
7475
7476 ** Changes in sort.el
7477
7478 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
7479 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
7480 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
7481 numeric base.
7482
7483 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
7484
7485 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
7486 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
7487 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
7488
7489 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
7490 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
7491
7492 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
7493 output ^M at the end of lines.
7494
7495 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
7496 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
7497
7498 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
7499 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
7500 `(msb-mode 1)'.
7501
7502 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
7503 group.
7504
7505 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
7506 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
7507 are recognized:
7508
7509 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
7510 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
7511 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
7512 nil -- just delete one character.
7513
7514 Default value is `untabify'.
7515
7516 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
7517
7518 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
7519 symbol, not double-quoted.
7520
7521 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
7522 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
7523 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
7524 moved to lisp/obsolete.
7525
7526 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
7527 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
7528 `auto-compression-mode' command.
7529
7530 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
7531 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
7532 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
7533
7534 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
7535 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
7536
7537 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
7538 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
7539
7540 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
7541 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
7542
7543 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
7544 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
7545 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
7546 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
7547 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
7548 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
7549
7550 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
7551 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
7552
7553 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
7554
7555 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
7556 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
7557
7558 ** Shell script mode changes.
7559
7560 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
7561 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
7562 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
7563
7564 ** Etags changes.
7565
7566 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
7567
7568 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
7569 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
7570 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
7571 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
7572 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
7573
7574 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
7575 declarations when given the --declarations option.
7576
7577 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
7578 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
7579
7580 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
7581 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
7582 `template' keywords.
7583
7584 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
7585 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
7586
7587 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
7588 types.
7589
7590 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
7591
7592 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
7593
7594 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
7595 are now tagged.
7596
7597 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
7598
7599 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
7600 variables are tagged.
7601
7602 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
7603
7604 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
7605 for PSWrap.
7606
7607 ** Changes in etags.el
7608
7609 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
7610 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
7611 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
7612
7613 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
7614 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
7615
7616 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
7617 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
7618 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
7619 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
7620
7621 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
7622
7623 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
7624 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
7625
7626 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
7627
7628 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
7629 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
7630 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
7631
7632 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
7633 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
7634
7635 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
7636 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
7637
7638 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
7639 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
7640 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
7641 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
7642 point will go to the beginning of the file.
7643
7644 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
7645 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
7646 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
7647
7648 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
7649 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
7650 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
7651
7652 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
7653 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
7654 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
7655
7656 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
7657
7658 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
7659
7660 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
7661 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
7662 expression from that list, are not checked.
7663
7664 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
7665 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
7666 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
7667 the buffer, just like for the local files.
7668
7669 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
7670
7671 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
7672 displays local abbrevs, only.
7673
7674 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
7675 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
7676
7677 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
7678 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
7679 is measured in pixels.
7680
7681 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
7682 to be visited as images.
7683
7684 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
7685 were added to compile.el.
7686
7687 ** Withdrawn packages
7688
7689 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
7690 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
7691
7692 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
7693
7694 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
7695
7696 \f
7697 * Incompatible Lisp changes
7698
7699 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
7700 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
7701 See the sections below for details.
7702
7703 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
7704 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
7705 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
7706 to remove the properties of the copy.
7707
7708 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
7709 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
7710 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
7711 these properties are active.
7712
7713 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
7714 ranges may affect some code.
7715
7716 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
7717 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
7718 make a difference to some code.
7719
7720 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
7721 operates on the minibuffer.
7722
7723 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7724 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
7725 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
7726 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
7727 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
7728 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
7729 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
7730 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
7731 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
7732 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
7733 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
7734 the buffer as multibyte characters.
7735
7736 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
7737 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
7738 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
7739
7740 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
7741 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
7742 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7743
7744 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
7745 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
7746 such as `mapconcat'.
7747
7748 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
7749 string.
7750
7751 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
7752 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
7753 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
7754 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
7755 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
7756 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
7757 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
7758 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
7759
7760 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
7761 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
7762 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
7763 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
7764 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
7765 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
7766 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
7767 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
7768 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
7769 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7770
7771 \f
7772 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
7773 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
7774
7775 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
7776
7777 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
7778 allows the animated display of strings.
7779
7780 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
7781 interactive form of a function.
7782
7783 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
7784 between custom options. Example:
7785
7786 (defcustom default-input-method nil
7787 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
7788 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
7789 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
7790 :group 'mule
7791 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
7792 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
7793
7794 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
7795 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
7796 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
7797
7798 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
7799 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
7800 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
7801 (signal or normal termination).
7802
7803 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
7804 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
7805
7806 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
7807 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
7808
7809 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
7810 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
7811
7812 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
7813
7814 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
7815 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
7816 being deleted.
7817
7818 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
7819
7820 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
7821 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
7822 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
7823 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
7824 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
7825 charset.
7826
7827 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
7828 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
7829 message.
7830
7831 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
7832 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
7833
7834 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
7835 with the more general `:mask' property.
7836
7837 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
7838
7839 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
7840 backslash.
7841
7842 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
7843 is running in batch mode. For example,
7844
7845 (message "%s" (read t))
7846
7847 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
7848 to standard output.
7849
7850 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
7851 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
7852
7853 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
7854 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
7855 frame or window.
7856
7857 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
7858 were added
7859
7860 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
7861
7862 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
7863 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
7864
7865 - Function: remq ELT LIST
7866
7867 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
7868 comparison is done with `eq'.
7869
7870 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
7871
7872 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
7873 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
7874 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
7875
7876 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
7877 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
7878 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
7879
7880 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
7881 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
7882
7883 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
7884 function was declared obsolete.
7885
7886 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7887 retained as an alias).
7888
7889 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
7890 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
7891
7892 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
7893
7894 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
7895
7896 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
7897 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
7898 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
7899 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
7900 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
7901 means never include the minibuffer window.
7902
7903 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
7904
7905 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
7906
7907 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
7908
7909 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
7910 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
7911 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
7912 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
7913 returned.
7914
7915 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
7916 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
7917 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
7918 minibuffer even if it is active.
7919
7920 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
7921 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
7922 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
7923 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
7924 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
7925 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
7926
7927 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
7928 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
7929 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
7930 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
7931 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
7932 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
7933 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
7934
7935 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
7936 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
7937 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
7938
7939 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
7940 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
7941 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
7942 Default value is nil.
7943
7944 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
7945 meaning no limit.
7946
7947 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
7948 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
7949 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
7950
7951 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
7952 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
7953 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
7954
7955 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
7956 list of a primitive.
7957
7958 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
7959
7960 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
7961 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
7962 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
7963 than replacing the local map.
7964
7965 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
7966 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
7967 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
7968 instead.
7969
7970 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
7971
7972 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
7973 as promised long ago.
7974
7975 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
7976
7977 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
7978 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
7979 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
7980
7981 \f
7982 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
7983
7984 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
7985 regular expressions.
7986
7987 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
7988
7989 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7990
7991 - Macro: rx SEXP
7992
7993 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7994
7995 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
7996 notation.
7997
7998 STRING
7999 matches string STRING literally.
8000
8001 CHAR
8002 matches character CHAR literally.
8003
8004 `not-newline'
8005 matches any character except a newline.
8006 .
8007 `anything'
8008 matches any character
8009
8010 `(any SET)'
8011 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
8012 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
8013
8014 '(in SET)'
8015 like `any'.
8016
8017 `(not (any SET))'
8018 matches any character not in SET
8019
8020 `line-start'
8021 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
8022 in the text being matched
8023
8024 `line-end'
8025 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
8026
8027 `string-start'
8028 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
8029 string being matched against.
8030
8031 `string-end'
8032 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
8033 string being matched against.
8034
8035 `buffer-start'
8036 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
8037 buffer being matched against.
8038
8039 `buffer-end'
8040 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
8041 buffer being matched against.
8042
8043 `point'
8044 matches the empty string, but only at point.
8045
8046 `word-start'
8047 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
8048 word.
8049
8050 `word-end'
8051 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
8052
8053 `word-boundary'
8054 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
8055 word.
8056
8057 `(not word-boundary)'
8058 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
8059 word.
8060
8061 `digit'
8062 matches 0 through 9.
8063
8064 `control'
8065 matches ASCII control characters.
8066
8067 `hex-digit'
8068 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8069
8070 `blank'
8071 matches space and tab only.
8072
8073 `graphic'
8074 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8075 space, and DEL.
8076
8077 `printing'
8078 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8079 and DEL.
8080
8081 `alphanumeric'
8082 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8083 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8084
8085 `letter'
8086 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8087 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8088
8089 `ascii'
8090 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8091
8092 `nonascii'
8093 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8094
8095 `lower'
8096 matches anything lower-case.
8097
8098 `upper'
8099 matches anything upper-case.
8100
8101 `punctuation'
8102 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8103 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8104
8105 `space'
8106 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8107
8108 `word'
8109 matches anything that has word syntax.
8110
8111 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
8112 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
8113 of the following symbols.
8114
8115 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
8116 `punctuation' (\\s.)
8117 `word' (\\sw)
8118 `symbol' (\\s_)
8119 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
8120 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
8121 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
8122 `string-quote' (\\s\")
8123 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
8124 `escape' (\\s\\)
8125 `character-quote' (\\s/)
8126 `comment-start' (\\s<)
8127 `comment-end' (\\s>)
8128
8129 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
8130 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
8131
8132 `(category CATEGORY)'
8133 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
8134 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
8135
8136 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
8137 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
8138 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
8139 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
8140 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
8141 `symbol' (\\c5)
8142 `digit' (\\c6)
8143 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
8144 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
8145 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
8146 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
8147 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
8148 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
8149 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
8150 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
8151 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
8152 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
8153 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
8154 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
8155 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
8156 `ascii' (\\ca)
8157 `arabic' (\\cb)
8158 `chinese' (\\cc)
8159 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
8160 `greek' (\\cg)
8161 `korean' (\\ch)
8162 `indian' (\\ci)
8163 `japanese' (\\cj)
8164 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
8165 `latin' (\\cl)
8166 `lao' (\\co)
8167 `tibetan' (\\cq)
8168 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
8169 `thai' (\\ct)
8170 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
8171 `hebrew' (\\cw)
8172 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
8173 `can-break' (\\c|)
8174
8175 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
8176 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
8177
8178 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8179 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
8180
8181 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8182 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
8183 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
8184
8185 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8186 another name for `submatch'.
8187
8188 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8189 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
8190 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
8191 regular expression.
8192
8193 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
8194 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
8195 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
8196 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
8197 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
8198
8199 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
8200 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
8201
8202 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
8203 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8204
8205 `(0+ SEXP)'
8206 like `zero-or-more'.
8207
8208 `(* SEXP)'
8209 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8210
8211 `(*? SEXP)'
8212 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8213
8214 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
8215 matches one or more occurrences of A.
8216
8217 `(1+ SEXP)'
8218 like `one-or-more'.
8219
8220 `(+ SEXP)'
8221 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8222
8223 `(+? SEXP)'
8224 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8225
8226 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
8227 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
8228
8229 `(optional SEXP)'
8230 like `zero-or-one'.
8231
8232 `(? SEXP)'
8233 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8234
8235 `(?? SEXP)'
8236 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8237
8238 `(repeat N SEXP)'
8239 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8240
8241 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
8242 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8243
8244 `(eval FORM)'
8245 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
8246 `regexp-quote' it.
8247
8248 `(regexp REGEXP)'
8249 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
8250
8251 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
8252
8253 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
8254 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
8255 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
8256 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
8257
8258 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
8259 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
8260 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
8261 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
8262
8263 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
8264 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
8265 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
8266
8267 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
8268 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
8269 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
8270 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
8271 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
8272 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
8273 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
8274 eight-bit-graphic.
8275
8276 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
8277
8278 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
8279 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
8280 character set as previously.
8281
8282 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
8283 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
8284 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
8285
8286 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
8287 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
8288 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
8289 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
8290
8291 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
8292 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
8293
8294 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
8295 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
8296 "fontset-default".
8297
8298 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
8299 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
8300
8301 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
8302 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
8303 buffers and strings.
8304
8305 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
8306 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
8307 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
8308 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
8309 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
8310 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
8311 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
8312 also been deleted.
8313
8314 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
8315 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
8316 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
8317
8318 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
8319 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
8320 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
8321 may differ between buffer and string text.
8322
8323 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
8324 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
8325
8326 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
8327 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
8328 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
8329 `composition' from STRING.
8330
8331 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
8332 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
8333
8334 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
8335 obsolete.
8336
8337 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
8338 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
8339
8340 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
8341 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
8342 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
8343 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
8344
8345 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
8346 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
8347 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
8348 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
8349 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
8350 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
8351
8352 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
8353 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
8354 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
8355
8356 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
8357 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
8358 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
8359
8360 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
8361 have been introduced.
8362
8363 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
8364 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
8365 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
8366 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
8367 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
8368 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
8369 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
8370 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
8371 their multibyte equivalent.
8372
8373 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
8374 that offset in the file before writing.
8375
8376 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
8377 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
8378
8379 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
8380 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
8381 from which the command was issued.
8382
8383 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
8384 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
8385 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
8386 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
8387 operate on.
8388
8389 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
8390 to `window-buffer-height'.
8391
8392 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
8393
8394 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
8395 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
8396 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
8397
8398 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
8399 respectively.
8400
8401 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
8402 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
8403
8404 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
8405 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
8406 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
8407
8408 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
8409 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
8410 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
8411 is currently displayed in some window.
8412
8413 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
8414 argument function's results.
8415
8416 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
8417 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
8418 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
8419 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
8420 sequence).
8421
8422 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
8423 header in the list of headers passed to it.
8424
8425 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
8426 ignores differences in case and text representation.
8427
8428 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
8429 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
8430 as follows:
8431
8432 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
8433 nil don't display a cursor
8434 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
8435 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
8436 others display a box cursor.
8437
8438 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
8439 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
8440 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
8441 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
8442
8443 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
8444 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
8445 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
8446 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
8447
8448 Example:
8449
8450 (string-to-syntax "()")
8451 => (4 . 41)
8452
8453 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
8454 other than 10.
8455
8456 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
8457 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
8458
8459 #b1111
8460 => 15
8461 #b-1111
8462 => -15
8463
8464 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
8465
8466 #o666
8467 => 438
8468
8469 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
8470
8471 #xbeef
8472 => 48815
8473
8474 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
8475
8476 #2R-111
8477 => -7
8478 #25rah
8479 => 267
8480
8481 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
8482 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
8483 and isn't a string.
8484
8485 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
8486 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
8487 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
8488 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
8489
8490 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
8491
8492 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
8493 for a regexp in a string.
8494
8495 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
8496 `mouse-position-function'.
8497
8498 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
8499 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
8500
8501 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
8502 Keywords are now always considered constants.
8503
8504 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
8505 returns it.
8506
8507 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
8508 returned by function `recent-keys'.
8509
8510 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
8511 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
8512 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
8513 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
8514 mode.
8515
8516 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
8517 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
8518
8519 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
8520 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
8521 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
8522 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
8523 been performed."
8524
8525 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
8526 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
8527 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
8528 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
8529
8530 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
8531 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
8532 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
8533
8534 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
8535 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
8536 specified table.
8537
8538 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
8539
8540 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
8541 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
8542 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
8543 what BODY returns.
8544
8545 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
8546 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8547 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
8548 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
8549 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8550
8551 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
8552 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
8553
8554 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
8555 instead of being optional.
8556
8557 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
8558 modify read-only text.
8559
8560 ** New functions and variables for locales.
8561
8562 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
8563 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
8564 time functions like strftime. The new variables
8565 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
8566 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
8567
8568 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
8569 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
8570 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
8571 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
8572 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
8573 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
8574 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
8575
8576 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
8577 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
8578 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
8579 start sequences.
8580
8581 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
8582 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
8583
8584 ** New function `propertize'
8585
8586 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
8587 strings with text properties.
8588
8589 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
8590
8591 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
8592 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
8593 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
8594 specified value of that property. Example:
8595
8596 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
8597
8598 ** push and pop macros.
8599
8600 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
8601 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
8602 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
8603
8604 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
8605 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
8606 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
8607
8608 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
8609
8610 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
8611 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
8612
8613 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
8614 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
8615 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
8616 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8617
8618 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
8619 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
8620 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
8621 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8622
8623 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
8624 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
8625 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
8626 or a sign.
8627
8628 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
8629 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
8630 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8631 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
8632 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8633 space, and DEL.
8634 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8635 and DEL.
8636 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
8637 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8638 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8639 [:alpha:] matches letters.
8640 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8641 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8642 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8643 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8644 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
8645 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
8646 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8647 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8648 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8649 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
8650 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
8651
8652 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
8653
8654 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
8655
8656 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
8657
8658 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
8659 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
8660
8661 :test TEST
8662
8663 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
8664 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
8665 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
8666
8667 :size SIZE
8668
8669 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
8670 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
8671
8672 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
8673
8674 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
8675 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
8676 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
8677 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
8678 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
8679
8680 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
8681
8682 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
8683 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
8684 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
8685
8686 :weakness WEAK
8687
8688 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
8689 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
8690 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
8691 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
8692 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
8693
8694 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
8695
8696 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
8697
8698 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
8699
8700 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
8701
8702 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
8703
8704 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
8705 values are shared.
8706
8707 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
8708
8709 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
8710
8711 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8712
8713 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
8714
8715 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
8716
8717 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
8718
8719 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8720
8721 Returns the size of TABLE.
8722
8723 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
8724
8725 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
8726
8727 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
8728
8729 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
8730
8731 - Function: clrhash TABLE
8732
8733 Clear TABLE.
8734
8735 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
8736
8737 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
8738 not found.
8739
8740 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
8741
8742 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
8743 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
8744
8745 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
8746
8747 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
8748
8749 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
8750
8751 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
8752 arguments KEY and VALUE.
8753
8754 - Function: sxhash OBJ
8755
8756 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
8757
8758 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
8759
8760 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
8761 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
8762 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
8763 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
8764 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
8765
8766 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
8767
8768 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
8769 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
8770 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
8771
8772 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
8773 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
8774
8775 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
8776 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
8777
8778 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
8779 (sxhash (upcase a)))
8780
8781 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
8782 'case-fold-string-hash))
8783
8784 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
8785
8786 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
8787
8788 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
8789 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
8790 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
8791
8792 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
8793
8794 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
8795 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
8796
8797 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
8798 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
8799 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
8800 is too short to reach that column.
8801
8802 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
8803 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
8804 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
8805 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
8806
8807 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
8808 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
8809 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
8810
8811 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
8812 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
8813
8814 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
8815 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
8816
8817 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
8818 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
8819 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
8820 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
8821 temporary-file-directory instead.
8822
8823 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
8824 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
8825 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
8826 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
8827
8828 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
8829 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
8830
8831 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
8832
8833 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
8834 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
8835 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
8836
8837 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
8838
8839 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
8840 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
8841 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
8842 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
8843 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
8844 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
8845
8846 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
8847 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
8848 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
8849 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
8850
8851 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
8852
8853 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
8854 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
8855 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
8856 result string.
8857
8858 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
8859 string where arguments appear in the result string.
8860
8861 Example:
8862
8863 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
8864 (s2 "world"))
8865 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
8866 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
8867 (format s1 s2))
8868
8869 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
8870
8871 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
8872
8873 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
8874 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
8875 argument in it.
8876
8877 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
8878 (arg "world"))
8879 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
8880 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
8881 (message msg arg))
8882
8883 ** Sound support
8884
8885 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
8886 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
8887
8888 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
8889 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
8890 to enable sound support.
8891
8892 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
8893 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
8894 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
8895 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
8896 sound to play, before playing the sound.
8897
8898 The following sound properties are supported:
8899
8900 - `:file FILE'
8901
8902 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
8903 searched relative to `data-directory'.
8904
8905 - `:data DATA'
8906
8907 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
8908 may be present, but not both.
8909
8910 - `:volume VOLUME'
8911
8912 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
8913 0..1. This property is optional.
8914
8915 - `:device DEVICE'
8916
8917 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
8918 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
8919
8920 Other properties are ignored.
8921
8922 An alternative interface is called as
8923 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
8924
8925 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
8926
8927 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
8928 a keyword symbol.
8929
8930 ** Changes to garbage collection
8931
8932 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
8933 of live and free strings.
8934
8935 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
8936 strings that have been consed so far.
8937
8938 \f
8939 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
8940 Lisp Manual
8941
8942 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
8943 mini-windows.
8944
8945 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
8946 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
8947 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
8948
8949 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
8950
8951 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
8952
8953 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
8954 image.
8955
8956 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
8957
8958 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
8959
8960 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
8961 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
8962 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
8963 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
8964 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
8965
8966 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
8967 has a mask bitmap.
8968
8969 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
8970
8971 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
8972 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
8973 or omitted means use the selected frame.
8974
8975 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
8976 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
8977
8978 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
8979 optional.
8980
8981 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
8982 below).
8983
8984 \f
8985 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
8986
8987 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
8988 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
8989
8990 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
8991 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
8992 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
8993 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
8994 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
8995 just display it black instead.
8996
8997 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
8998 a line like
8999
9000 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
9001
9002 in your `.emacs'.
9003
9004 ** New face implementation.
9005
9006 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
9007 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
9008
9009 *** New faces.
9010
9011 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
9012
9013 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
9014
9015 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
9016 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
9017
9018 3. Font height in 1/10pt
9019
9020 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
9021
9022 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
9023
9024 6. Foreground color.
9025
9026 7. Background color.
9027
9028 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
9029
9030 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
9031
9032 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
9033
9034 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
9035
9036 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
9037 color.
9038
9039 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
9040 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
9041
9042 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
9043 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
9044 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
9045 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
9046 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
9047 attributes mentioned above.
9048
9049 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
9050 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
9051 created frames.
9052
9053 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
9054 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
9055 `fully-specified'.
9056
9057 *** Face merging.
9058
9059 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
9060 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
9061 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
9062 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
9063 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
9064 results in a fully-specified face.
9065
9066 *** Face realization.
9067
9068 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
9069 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
9070 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
9071 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
9072 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
9073 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
9074
9075 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
9076 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
9077 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
9078 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
9079
9080 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
9081 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
9082 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
9083 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
9084 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
9085
9086 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
9087 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
9088 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
9089 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
9090 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
9091 Emacs.
9092
9093 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
9094 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
9095 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
9096 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
9097
9098 **** Clearing face caches.
9099
9100 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
9101 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
9102 unused fonts.
9103
9104 *** Font selection.
9105
9106 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
9107 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
9108 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
9109
9110 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
9111 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
9112 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
9113 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
9114 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
9115
9116 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
9117 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
9118 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
9119
9120 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
9121
9122 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
9123 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
9124 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
9125 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
9126 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
9127 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
9128 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
9129
9130 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
9131 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
9132 doesn't exist.
9133
9134 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
9135 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
9136 registry.
9137
9138 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
9139 slightly different.
9140
9141 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
9142
9143
9144 **** Scalable fonts
9145
9146 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
9147 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
9148 servers.
9149
9150 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
9151 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
9152 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
9153 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
9154 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
9155 that list. Example:
9156
9157 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
9158
9159 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
9160
9161 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
9162
9163 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
9164
9165 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
9166 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
9167 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
9168
9169 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
9170 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
9171 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
9172 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
9173 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
9174 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
9175 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
9176 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
9177 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
9178 of the face font sort order.
9179
9180 - Function: x-font-family-list
9181
9182 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
9183 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
9184 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
9185 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
9186
9187 - Variable: font-list-limit
9188
9189 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
9190 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
9191 matching font. The default is currently 100.
9192
9193 *** Setting face attributes.
9194
9195 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
9196 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
9197 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
9198 `face-attribute'.
9199
9200 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
9201 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
9202
9203 The following attributes are recognized:
9204
9205 `:family'
9206
9207 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
9208 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
9209 and `?' are allowed.
9210
9211 `:width'
9212
9213 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
9214 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
9215 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
9216 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
9217
9218 `:height'
9219
9220 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
9221 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
9222 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
9223 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
9224
9225 `:weight'
9226
9227 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
9228 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
9229 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
9230
9231 `:slant'
9232
9233 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
9234 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
9235 `reverse-oblique'.
9236
9237 `:foreground', `:background'
9238
9239 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
9240
9241 `:underline'
9242
9243 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
9244 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
9245 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
9246 don't underline.
9247
9248 `:overline'
9249
9250 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
9251 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
9252 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
9253 overline.
9254
9255 `:strike-through'
9256
9257 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
9258 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
9259 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
9260 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
9261
9262 `:box'
9263
9264 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
9265 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
9266 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
9267 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
9268 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
9269 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
9270 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
9271 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
9272 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
9273 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
9274 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
9275 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
9276 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
9277 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
9278 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
9279 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
9280 box.
9281
9282 `:inverse-video'
9283
9284 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
9285 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
9286
9287 `:stipple'
9288
9289 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
9290 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
9291 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
9292 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
9293 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
9294 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
9295
9296 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
9297 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
9298
9299 `:font'
9300
9301 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
9302 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
9303 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
9304 versions of Emacs.
9305
9306 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
9307 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
9308 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
9309
9310 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
9311 `defface'.
9312
9313 `:inherit'
9314
9315 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
9316 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
9317 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
9318
9319 *** Face attributes and X resources
9320
9321 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
9322 from X resources:
9323
9324 Face attribute X resource class
9325 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
9326 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
9327 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
9328 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
9329 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
9330 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
9331 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
9332 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
9333 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
9334 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
9335 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
9336 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
9337 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
9338 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
9339 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
9340 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
9341 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
9342 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
9343 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
9344 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
9345
9346 *** Text property `face'.
9347
9348 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
9349 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
9350 specification can be
9351
9352 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
9353
9354 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
9355 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
9356 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
9357 for face attribute names.
9358
9359 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
9360 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
9361 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
9362
9363 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
9364
9365 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
9366 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
9367 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
9368 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
9369 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
9370 used to clear the mapping table.
9371
9372 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
9373
9374 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
9375 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
9376 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
9377 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
9378 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
9379 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
9380 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
9381 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
9382 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
9383 modify their color-related behavior.
9384
9385 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
9386 any frame type.
9387
9388 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
9389
9390 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
9391 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
9392 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
9393 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
9394 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
9395 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
9396 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
9397 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
9398 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
9399
9400 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
9401 display can display image files.
9402
9403 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
9404
9405 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
9406 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
9407 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
9408 `Inviolable' option.
9409
9410 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
9411 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
9412 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
9413
9414 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
9415
9416 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
9417 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
9418 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
9419
9420 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
9421 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
9422 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
9423 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
9424 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
9425 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
9426 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
9427 functions.
9428
9429 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
9430 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
9431 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
9432
9433 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
9434
9435 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
9436
9437 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
9438
9439 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9440 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
9441 constrained position if that is different.
9442
9443 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
9444 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
9445 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
9446 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
9447 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9448 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
9449 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
9450 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
9451 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
9452
9453 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
9454 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
9455 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
9456 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
9457 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
9458
9459 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
9460 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
9461
9462 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
9463
9464 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
9465
9466 Delete the field surrounding POS.
9467 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9468 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9469
9470 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9471
9472 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
9473 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9474 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9475 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
9476 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
9477
9478 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9479
9480 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
9481 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9482 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9483 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
9484 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
9485
9486 - Function: field-string &optional POS
9487
9488 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
9489 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9490 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9491
9492 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
9493
9494 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
9495 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9496 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9497
9498 ** Image support.
9499
9500 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
9501 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
9502 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
9503 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
9504
9505 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
9506 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
9507 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
9508 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
9509 area.
9510
9511 IMAGE is an image specification.
9512
9513 *** Image specifications
9514
9515 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
9516 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
9517 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
9518 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
9519 described below are ignored.
9520
9521 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
9522
9523 `:ascent ASCENT'
9524
9525 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
9526 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
9527 to use for its ascent.
9528
9529 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
9530 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
9531
9532 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
9533 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
9534 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
9535 overlays that apply to the image.
9536
9537 `:margin MARGIN'
9538
9539 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
9540 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
9541 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
9542
9543 `:relief RELIEF'
9544
9545 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
9546 around an image.
9547
9548 `:conversion ALGO'
9549
9550 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
9551
9552 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
9553 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
9554
9555 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
9556 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
9557 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
9558 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
9559 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
9560 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
9561 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
9562 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
9563 below.
9564
9565 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
9566 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
9567 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
9568
9569 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
9570 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
9571 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
9572 of the factors' absolute values.
9573
9574 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
9575
9576 (1 0 0
9577 0 0 0
9578 9 9 -1)
9579
9580 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
9581
9582 ( 2 -1 0
9583 -1 0 1
9584 0 1 -2)
9585
9586 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
9587 ``disabled''.
9588
9589 `:mask MASK'
9590
9591 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
9592 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
9593 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
9594 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
9595 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
9596 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
9597 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
9598 image.
9599
9600 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
9601 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
9602 `:mask nil'.
9603
9604 `:file FILE'
9605
9606 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
9607 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
9608 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
9609 may be present in the image specification.
9610
9611 `:data DATA'
9612
9613 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
9614 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
9615 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
9616 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
9617
9618 *** Supported image types
9619
9620 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
9621
9622 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
9623 properties supported are:
9624
9625 `:foreground FG'
9626
9627 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9628 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9629
9630 `:background BG'
9631
9632 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9633 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9634
9635 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
9636 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
9637 instead of a `:file' property.
9638
9639 `:width WIDTH'
9640
9641 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
9642
9643 `:height HEIGHT'
9644
9645 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
9646
9647 `:data DATA'
9648
9649 DATA must be either
9650
9651 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
9652 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
9653
9654 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
9655
9656 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
9657 bitmap.
9658
9659 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
9660 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
9661 in the file.
9662
9663 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
9664
9665 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
9666 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
9667 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
9668 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
9669
9670 Additional image properties supported are:
9671
9672 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
9673
9674 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
9675 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
9676 name.
9677
9678 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
9679 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
9680
9681 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
9682 to display compressed images.
9683
9684 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
9685
9686 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
9687 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
9688 mono images are:
9689
9690 `:foreground FG'
9691
9692 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9693 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9694
9695 `:background FG'
9696
9697 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9698 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9699
9700 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
9701
9702 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
9703 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9704 properties defined.
9705
9706 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
9707
9708 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
9709 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9710 properties defined.
9711
9712 **** GIF, image type `gif'
9713
9714 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
9715 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
9716
9717 Additional image properties supported are:
9718
9719 `:index INDEX'
9720
9721 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
9722 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
9723 as a hollow box.
9724
9725 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
9726 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
9727 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
9728 every 0.1 seconds.
9729
9730 (defun show-anim (file max)
9731 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
9732 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
9733
9734 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
9735 (when (= idx max)
9736 (setq idx 0))
9737 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
9738 (save-excursion
9739 (set-buffer buffer)
9740 (goto-char (point-min))
9741 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
9742 (insert-image img "x"))
9743 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
9744
9745 **** PNG, image type `png'
9746
9747 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
9748 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9749 properties defined.
9750
9751 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
9752
9753 Additional image properties supported are:
9754
9755 `:pt-width WIDTH'
9756
9757 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
9758 integer. This is a required property.
9759
9760 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
9761
9762 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
9763 must be a integer. This is an required property.
9764
9765 `:bounding-box BOX'
9766
9767 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
9768 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
9769 files. This is an required property.
9770
9771 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
9772 lisp/gs.el.
9773
9774 *** Lisp interface.
9775
9776 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
9777 which are supported in the current configuration.
9778
9779 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
9780 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
9781 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
9782 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
9783 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
9784
9785 *** Simplified image API, image.el
9786
9787 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
9788 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
9789 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
9790 define an image based on available image types. The functions
9791 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
9792 buffer.
9793
9794 ** Display margins.
9795
9796 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
9797 and images.
9798
9799 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
9800 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
9801 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
9802 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
9803 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
9804 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
9805 of the display margins.
9806
9807 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
9808 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
9809 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
9810 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
9811 in this file).
9812
9813 ** Help display
9814
9815 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
9816 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
9817 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
9818 that have a `help-echo' property.
9819
9820 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
9821 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
9822 the window in which the help was found.
9823
9824 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
9825 `help-echo' text property was found.
9826
9827 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
9828 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
9829
9830 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
9831 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
9832 mouse.
9833
9834 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
9835 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
9836
9837 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
9838 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
9839 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
9840 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
9841 used as help string.
9842
9843 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
9844 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
9845 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
9846
9847 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
9848
9849 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
9850 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
9851
9852 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
9853 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
9854 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
9855 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
9856 used.
9857
9858 (global-set-key [A-down]
9859 #'(lambda ()
9860 (interactive)
9861 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9862 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
9863 (global-set-key [A-up]
9864 #'(lambda ()
9865 (interactive)
9866 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9867 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
9868
9869 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
9870
9871 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
9872 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
9873 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
9874 is called with one argument, POS.
9875
9876 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
9877 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
9878 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
9879 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
9880 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
9881
9882 ** Tool bar support.
9883
9884 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
9885 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
9886 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
9887 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
9888 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
9889 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
9890
9891 *** Tool bar item definitions
9892
9893 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
9894 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
9895 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
9896
9897 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
9898 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
9899 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
9900 property (see below).
9901
9902 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
9903 binding are currently ignored.
9904
9905 The following properties are recognized:
9906
9907 `:enable FORM'.
9908
9909 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
9910 or disabled.
9911
9912 `:visible FORM'
9913
9914 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
9915
9916 `:filter FUNCTION'
9917
9918 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
9919 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
9920 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
9921
9922 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
9923
9924 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
9925 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
9926
9927 `:image IMAGES'
9928
9929 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
9930 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
9931 meaning of each of the four elements:
9932
9933 Index Use when item is
9934 ----------------------------------------
9935 0 enabled and selected
9936 1 enabled and deselected
9937 2 disabled and selected
9938 3 disabled and deselected
9939
9940 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
9941 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
9942
9943 `:help HELP-STRING'.
9944
9945 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
9946 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
9947
9948 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
9949 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
9950 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
9951 menu bar.
9952
9953 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
9954 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
9955 buffer-locally to override the global map.
9956
9957 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
9958
9959 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
9960 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
9961 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
9962
9963 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
9964 raised when the mouse moves over them.
9965
9966 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
9967 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
9968 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
9969 vertical margins . Default is 1.
9970
9971 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
9972 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
9973
9974 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
9975
9976 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
9977 a tool bar item. If
9978
9979 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
9980 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
9981 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
9982
9983 is the original tool bar item definition, then
9984
9985 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
9986
9987 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
9988 item.
9989
9990 ** Mode line changes.
9991
9992 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
9993
9994 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
9995 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
9996 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
9997
9998 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
9999 a `local-map' text property.
10000
10001 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
10002 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
10003
10004 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
10005 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
10006 `local-map' property.
10007
10008 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
10009 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
10010 example.
10011
10012 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
10013 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
10014
10015 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
10016 variable mode-line-format to nil.
10017
10018 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
10019
10020 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
10021 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
10022 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
10023 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
10024 line.
10025
10026 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
10027 `header-line'.
10028
10029 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
10030 position in the header-line.
10031
10032 ** Text property `display'
10033
10034 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
10035 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
10036 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
10037 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
10038 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
10039
10040 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
10041
10042 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
10043 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
10044
10045 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
10046 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
10047 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
10048 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
10049 simpler form STRING as property value.
10050
10051 *** Variable width and height spaces
10052
10053 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
10054 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
10055 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
10056 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
10057 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
10058 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
10059 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
10060
10061 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
10062 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
10063 properties described below.
10064
10065 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
10066 characters having the `display' property.
10067
10068 - :width WIDTH
10069
10070 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
10071 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
10072
10073 - :relative-width FACTOR
10074
10075 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
10076 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
10077 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
10078 width of that character by FACTOR.
10079
10080 - :align-to HPOS
10081
10082 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
10083 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
10084
10085 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
10086
10087 - :height HEIGHT
10088
10089 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
10090 normal line height.
10091
10092 - :relative-height FACTOR
10093
10094 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
10095 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
10096
10097 - :ascent ASCENT
10098
10099 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
10100 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
10101 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
10102 equal to 100.
10103
10104 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
10105
10106 *** Images
10107
10108 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
10109 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
10110 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
10111 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
10112 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
10113 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
10114 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
10115 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
10116 as display specification.
10117
10118 *** Other display properties
10119
10120 - (space-width FACTOR)
10121
10122 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
10123 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
10124 integer or float.
10125
10126 - (height HEIGHT)
10127
10128 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
10129
10130 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
10131 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
10132 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
10133 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
10134 a font is available counts as a step.
10135
10136 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
10137 as tall as the frame's default font.
10138
10139 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
10140 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
10141
10142 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
10143 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
10144
10145 - (raise FACTOR)
10146
10147 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
10148 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
10149 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
10150 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
10151 `height' subproperty.
10152
10153 *** Conditional display properties
10154
10155 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
10156 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
10157 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
10158 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
10159 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
10160 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
10161 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
10162 different when object is a string.
10163
10164 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
10165 `(when t . SPEC)'.
10166
10167 ** New menu separator types.
10168
10169 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
10170 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
10171 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
10172 to specify other menu separator types.
10173
10174 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
10175
10176 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
10177 separator occurs.
10178
10179 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
10180
10181 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
10182
10183 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
10184
10185 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
10186
10187 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
10188
10189 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
10190
10191 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
10192
10193 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
10194
10195 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
10196
10197 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
10198 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
10199
10200 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
10201
10202 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
10203
10204 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
10205
10206 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
10207
10208 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
10209
10210 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
10211
10212 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
10213
10214 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
10215
10216 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
10217
10218 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
10219
10220 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
10221
10222 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
10223
10224 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
10225
10226 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
10227
10228 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
10229 the corresponding single-line separators.
10230
10231 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
10232
10233 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
10234 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
10235 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
10236 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
10237 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
10238 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
10239 default foreground is black.
10240
10241 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
10242 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
10243 `ScrollBarBackground').
10244
10245 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
10246 settings for scroll bar colors.
10247
10248 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
10249 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
10250
10251 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
10252 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
10253 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
10254 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
10255 the original window start.
10256
10257 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
10258 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
10259 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
10260
10261 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
10262
10263 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
10264 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
10265 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
10266 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
10267
10268 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
10269 fixed-width and fixed-height.
10270
10271 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
10272
10273 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
10274 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
10275 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
10276 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
10277 temporarily to nil, for example
10278
10279 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
10280 (enlarge-window 10))
10281
10282 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
10283 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
10284
10285 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
10286 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
10287 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
10288 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
10289 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
10290 support a vertical-bar cursor).
10291
10292
10293 \f
10294 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
10295
10296 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
10297 input.
10298
10299 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
10300
10301 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
10302
10303 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
10304 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
10305 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
10306 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
10307 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
10308
10309 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
10310 been added.
10311
10312 \f
10313 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
10314
10315 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
10316
10317
10318 \f
10319 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
10320
10321 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
10322 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
10323 \f
10324 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
10325
10326 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
10327
10328 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
10329 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
10330 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
10331
10332 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
10333 is the one that is used.
10334
10335 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
10336 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
10337 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
10338 separate from the command's regular output.
10339 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
10340 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
10341 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
10342 the buffer name.
10343
10344 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
10345 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
10346 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
10347 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
10348
10349 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
10350 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
10351 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
10352 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
10353
10354 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
10355 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
10356 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
10357 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
10358
10359 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
10360 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
10361 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
10362 they never ignore case.
10363
10364 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
10365 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
10366 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
10367 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
10368 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
10369 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
10370 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
10371
10372 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
10373 the same format that was used in the file before.
10374
10375 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
10376 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
10377
10378 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
10379 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
10380 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
10381
10382 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
10383 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
10384 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
10385 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
10386 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
10387 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
10388 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
10389
10390 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
10391 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
10392 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
10393 format. You can now customize these variables.
10394
10395 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
10396 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
10397 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
10398 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
10399
10400 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
10401 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
10402 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
10403
10404 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
10405 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
10406 doesn't have any effect.
10407
10408 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
10409 not one per buffer.
10410
10411 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
10412 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
10413 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
10414
10415 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
10416 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
10417 `auto-show-mode' command.
10418
10419 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
10420 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
10421 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
10422 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
10423 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
10424
10425 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
10426 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
10427
10428 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
10429 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
10430 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
10431
10432 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
10433 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
10434 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
10435 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
10436
10437 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
10438
10439 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
10440 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
10441 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
10442 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
10443 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
10444
10445 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
10446 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
10447
10448 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
10449 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
10450 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
10451 `?' on other systems.
10452
10453 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
10454 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
10455 Unix.
10456
10457 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
10458 current codepage when it starts.
10459
10460 ** Mail changes
10461
10462 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
10463 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
10464 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
10465 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
10466 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
10467 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
10468 latin-1:
10469
10470 MIME-version: 1.0
10471 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
10472 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
10473
10474 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
10475 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
10476 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
10477 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
10478 buffer-file-coding-system.
10479
10480 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
10481 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
10482 mail.
10483
10484 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
10485 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
10486 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
10487 list of possible coding systems.
10488
10489 ** CC Mode changes
10490
10491 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
10492 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
10493 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
10494 docstring for details.
10495
10496 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
10497 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
10498 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
10499 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
10500 lineup functions use this feature currently.
10501
10502 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
10503 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
10504
10505 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
10506 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
10507
10508 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
10509 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
10510 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
10511 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
10512 anonymous classes.
10513
10514 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
10515 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
10516
10517 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
10518 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
10519 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
10520 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
10521
10522 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
10523 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
10524 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
10525 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
10526 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
10527
10528 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
10529
10530 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
10531
10532 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
10533 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
10534
10535 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
10536
10537 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
10538 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
10539 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
10540 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
10541 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
10542
10543 ** Gnus changes.
10544
10545 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
10546 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
10547 Gnus manual for the full story.
10548
10549 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
10550 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
10551 group, which is created automatically.
10552
10553 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
10554 values.
10555
10556 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
10557
10558 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
10559 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
10560
10561 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
10562 `C-u C-c C-c'.
10563
10564 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
10565
10566 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
10567 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
10568
10569 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
10570
10571 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
10572 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
10573
10574 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
10575 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
10576
10577 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
10578 control over simplification.
10579
10580 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
10581
10582 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
10583 limit.
10584
10585 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
10586
10587 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
10588
10589 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
10590 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
10591 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
10592
10593 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
10594 `a' forces normal posting method.
10595
10596 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
10597 -- `W d'.
10598
10599 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
10600 to a non-nil value.
10601
10602 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
10603 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
10604
10605 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
10606 has been added.
10607
10608 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
10609
10610 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
10611
10612 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
10613 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
10614
10615 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
10616 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
10617
10618 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
10619
10620 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
10621 been added.
10622
10623 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
10624 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
10625
10626 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
10627 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
10628
10629 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
10630
10631 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
10632
10633 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
10634
10635 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
10636
10637 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
10638 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
10639 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
10640
10641 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
10642 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
10643 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
10644 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
10645 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
10646
10647 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
10648 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
10649 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
10650 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
10651
10652 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
10653 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
10654 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
10655 mismatch.
10656
10657 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10658
10659 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
10660 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
10661
10662 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
10663 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
10664 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
10665 removed from the label.
10666
10667 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
10668 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
10669
10670 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
10671 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
10672
10673 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
10674 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
10675 expressions.
10676
10677 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
10678
10679 ** New/deleted modes and packages
10680
10681 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
10682 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
10683
10684 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
10685 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
10686 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
10687
10688 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
10689 changes with a special face.
10690
10691 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
10692 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
10693 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
10694 \f
10695 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
10696
10697 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
10698 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
10699 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
10700 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
10701 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
10702
10703 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
10704 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
10705 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
10706
10707 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
10708 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
10709 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
10710 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
10711 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
10712 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
10713 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
10714 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
10715 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
10716
10717 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
10718 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
10719 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
10720 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
10721 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
10722 program.
10723
10724 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
10725 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
10726 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
10727 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
10728 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
10729 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
10730
10731 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
10732 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
10733 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
10734 was not documented clearly before.
10735
10736 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
10737 This includes Tetris and Snake.
10738 \f
10739 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
10740
10741 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
10742 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
10743 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
10744 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
10745
10746 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
10747 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
10748 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
10749
10750 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
10751
10752 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
10753 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
10754
10755 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
10756 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
10757 integers.
10758
10759 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
10760 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
10761 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
10762 file names and attributes are returned.
10763
10764 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
10765 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
10766 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
10767 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
10768 returns the result.
10769
10770 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
10771 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
10772
10773 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
10774
10775 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
10776 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
10777 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
10778 optionally.
10779
10780 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
10781 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
10782
10783 **
10784 The new function process-running-child-p
10785 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
10786 terminal to its own child process.
10787
10788 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
10789 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
10790 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
10791 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
10792
10793 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
10794 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
10795
10796 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
10797 :included is an alias for :visible.
10798
10799 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
10800 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
10801 to move or copy menu entries.
10802
10803 ** Multibyte editing changes
10804
10805 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
10806 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
10807 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
10808 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
10809 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
10810 (setq char (sref str idx)
10811 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
10812 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
10813
10814 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
10815 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
10816 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
10817
10818 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
10819 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
10820 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
10821
10822 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
10823
10824 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
10825 across the boundary.
10826
10827 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
10828 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
10829 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
10830 contains 8-bit characters.
10831 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
10832 contains invalid characters.
10833
10834 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
10835 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
10836 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
10837 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
10838 way.
10839
10840 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
10841 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
10842 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
10843 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
10844
10845 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
10846 compose Thai characters in a string.
10847
10848 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
10849 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
10850 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
10851 menus should always use the third argument.
10852
10853 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
10854 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
10855 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
10856 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
10857
10858 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
10859 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
10860 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
10861 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
10862
10863 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
10864 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
10865 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
10866 echo area contents.
10867
10868 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
10869
10870 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
10871 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
10872 requested feature cannot be loaded.
10873
10874 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
10875 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
10876 means to clear out that attribute.
10877
10878 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
10879 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
10880
10881 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
10882 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
10883 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
10884 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
10885
10886 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
10887 the gap of the current buffer.
10888
10889 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
10890 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
10891 current buffer.
10892
10893 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
10894 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
10895 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
10896 it back in after any modifications have been made.
10897 \f
10898 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
10899
10900 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
10901 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
10902 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
10903 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
10904 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
10905
10906 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
10907 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
10908 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
10909 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
10910 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
10911
10912 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
10913 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
10914 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
10915
10916 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
10917 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
10918 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
10919 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
10920 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
10921 results.
10922
10923 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
10924 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
10925 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
10926 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
10927 \f
10928 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
10929
10930 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
10931 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
10932 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
10933 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
10934
10935 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
10936 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
10937 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
10938 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
10939 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
10940 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
10941 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
10942 region.
10943
10944 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
10945 selective undo.
10946
10947 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
10948 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
10949 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
10950 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
10951 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
10952
10953 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
10954 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
10955 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
10956 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
10957
10958 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
10959 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
10960 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
10961 something that most users not do.
10962
10963 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
10964 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
10965 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
10966 applications.
10967
10968 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
10969 pasting operations.
10970
10971 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
10972 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
10973 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
10974 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
10975 `ps-printer-name'.
10976
10977 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
10978 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
10979 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
10980 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
10981 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
10982 hits a new word.
10983
10984 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
10985 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
10986 to be confused by TeX commands.
10987
10988 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
10989 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
10990 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
10991 of various alternative replacements and actions.
10992
10993 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
10994 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
10995 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
10996 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
10997 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
10998
10999 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
11000 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
11001
11002 ** Changes in input method usage.
11003
11004 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
11005 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
11006 respectively.
11007
11008 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
11009
11010 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
11011 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
11012
11013 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
11014 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
11015
11016 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
11017
11018 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
11019
11020 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
11021 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
11022
11023 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
11024 given in the following case:
11025 o When you are using a complex input method.
11026 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
11027
11028 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
11029 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
11030 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
11031 setting it to t is helpful.
11032
11033 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
11034
11035 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
11036 keys:
11037 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
11038 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
11039 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
11040 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
11041 environment.
11042
11043 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
11044 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
11045 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
11046 get
11047
11048 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
11049
11050 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
11051
11052 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
11053 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
11054
11055 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
11056 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
11057 its owner and group.
11058
11059 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
11060 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
11061
11062 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
11063 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
11064
11065 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
11066 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
11067 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
11068 by the left edge of the rectangle.
11069
11070 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
11071 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
11072 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
11073 for writing keyboard macros.
11074
11075 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
11076 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
11077 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
11078 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
11079 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
11080 info.
11081
11082 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
11083
11084 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
11085 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
11086 contents only.
11087
11088 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
11089 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
11090 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
11091 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
11092
11093 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
11094 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
11095 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
11096
11097 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
11098 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
11099 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
11100 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
11101
11102 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
11103 failure if the command produces no output.
11104
11105 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
11106 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
11107 the mouse.
11108
11109 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
11110 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
11111 function and variable names.
11112
11113 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
11114 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
11115 file-coding-system-alist.
11116
11117 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
11118 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
11119 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
11120 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
11121 according to the current fontset.
11122
11123 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
11124
11125 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
11126 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
11127 nonascii-insert-offset.
11128
11129 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
11130 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
11131 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
11132 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
11133
11134 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
11135 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
11136
11137 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
11138 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
11139
11140 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
11141 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
11142 command keys.
11143
11144 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
11145 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
11146
11147 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
11148 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
11149 all variables that have documentation.
11150
11151 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
11152 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
11153 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
11154 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
11155 it should show; the default is 20.
11156
11157 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
11158 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
11159 of your input.
11160
11161 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
11162 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
11163 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
11164 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
11165 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
11166 Newly added options are included as well.
11167
11168 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
11169 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
11170 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
11171
11172 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
11173 Customize menu.
11174
11175 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
11176 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
11177
11178 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
11179 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
11180 invoked.
11181
11182 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
11183 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
11184 The default is 1.
11185
11186 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
11187 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
11188 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
11189 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
11190 sensibly.
11191
11192 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
11193
11194 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
11195 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
11196 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
11197
11198 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
11199 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
11200 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
11201 every night.
11202
11203 ** Desktop changes
11204
11205 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
11206 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
11207
11208 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
11209 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
11210
11211 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
11212 read and post multi-lingual articles.
11213
11214 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
11215 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
11216 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
11217 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
11218 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
11219 made invisible again.
11220
11221 ** Mail reading and sending changes
11222
11223 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
11224 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
11225 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
11226 toggle.
11227
11228 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
11229 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
11230 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
11231 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
11232 rmail-default-body-file.
11233
11234 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
11235 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
11236 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
11237
11238 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
11239 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
11240 is evaluated to insert the signature.
11241
11242 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
11243 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
11244 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
11245 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
11246 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
11247 especially interested in trying feedmail.
11248
11249 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
11250 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
11251 provided by feedmail are:
11252
11253 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
11254 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
11255 there is also a queue for draft messages
11256
11257 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
11258 be prompted for confirmation
11259
11260 **** does smart filling of address headers
11261
11262 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
11263 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
11264 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
11265
11266 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
11267 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
11268 /usr/lib/sendmail, and Emacs Lisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
11269 function for something else (10-20 lines of Lisp code).
11270
11271 ** Dired changes
11272
11273 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
11274 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
11275
11276 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
11277 run Dired on the directory name at point.
11278
11279 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
11280 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
11281 for a specified regexp.
11282
11283 ** VC Changes
11284
11285 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
11286 conveniently.
11287
11288 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
11289 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
11290 Dired.
11291
11292 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
11293 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
11294 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
11295 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
11296
11297 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
11298 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
11299 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
11300 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
11301 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
11302
11303 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
11304 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
11305 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
11306 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
11307 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
11308
11309 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
11310 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
11311 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
11312 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
11313
11314 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
11315 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
11316 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
11317
11318 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
11319 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
11320 session to resolve them.
11321
11322 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
11323 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
11324 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
11325 uses as well).
11326
11327 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
11328 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
11329 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
11330 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
11331 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
11332 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
11333 using ediff.
11334
11335 ** Changes in Font Lock
11336
11337 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
11338 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
11339 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
11340 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
11341 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
11342
11343 ** Frame name display changes
11344
11345 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
11346 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
11347 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
11348 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
11349
11350 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
11351 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
11352 menu.
11353
11354 ** Comint (subshell) changes
11355
11356 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
11357 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
11358 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
11359
11360 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
11361
11362 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
11363 that is, the line after the last line you got.
11364 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
11365
11366 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
11367 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
11368 the following line.
11369
11370 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
11371 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
11372 previously sent input.
11373
11374 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
11375 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
11376 as the search string.
11377
11378 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
11379 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
11380
11381 ** C mode changes
11382
11383 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
11384 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
11385 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
11386 definition.
11387
11388 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
11389 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
11390 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
11391 style is still the default however.
11392
11393 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
11394
11395 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
11396 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
11397 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
11398
11399 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
11400 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
11401
11402 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
11403 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
11404
11405 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
11406 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
11407
11408 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
11409 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
11410
11411 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
11412 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
11413 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
11414 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
11415
11416 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
11417
11418 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
11419 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
11420 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
11421
11422 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
11423 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
11424 expanding dynamically.
11425
11426 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
11427 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
11428
11429 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
11430 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
11431 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
11432 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
11433
11434 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
11435
11436 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
11437
11438 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
11439 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
11440 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
11441 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
11442 against the first word in the title.
11443
11444 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
11445 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
11446 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
11447 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
11448 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
11449 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
11450
11451 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
11452 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
11453 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
11454 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
11455
11456 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
11457
11458 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
11459 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
11460 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
11461 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
11462 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
11463 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
11464
11465 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
11466 Editing group once the package is loaded.
11467
11468 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
11469 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
11470 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
11471
11472 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
11473 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
11474
11475 ** Ispell changes.
11476
11477 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
11478 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
11479 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
11480
11481 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
11482 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
11483 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
11484 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
11485 include:
11486
11487 o URLs are automatically skipped
11488 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
11489
11490 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
11491
11492 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
11493
11494 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
11495 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
11496 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
11497 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
11498
11499 *** New recursive parser.
11500
11501 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
11502 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
11503 recursive parser scans the individual files.
11504
11505 *** Parsing only part of a document.
11506
11507 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
11508 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
11509 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
11510
11511 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
11512
11513 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
11514
11515 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
11516
11517 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
11518
11519 *** Using multiple selection buffers
11520
11521 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
11522 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
11523
11524 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
11525
11526 *** References to external documents.
11527
11528 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
11529 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
11530 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
11531 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
11532 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
11533 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
11534 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
11535
11536 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
11537
11538 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
11539 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
11540
11541 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
11542 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
11543
11544 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
11545
11546 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
11547 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
11548
11549 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
11550
11551 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
11552 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
11553 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
11554 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
11555 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
11556 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
11557 more.
11558
11559 *** Support for the varioref package
11560
11561 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
11562
11563 *** New hooks
11564
11565 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
11566 and citations are created. These hooks are
11567 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
11568 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
11569
11570 *** Citations outside LaTeX
11571
11572 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
11573 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
11574
11575 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
11576
11577 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
11578 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
11579 fontified, use
11580
11581 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
11582
11583 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
11584 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
11585 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
11586 directories that contain the same file name.
11587
11588 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
11589 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
11590 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
11591 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
11592 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
11593 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
11594 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
11595 directory.
11596
11597 ** New modes and packages
11598
11599 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
11600 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
11601 it, but some do not.
11602
11603 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
11604 code.
11605
11606 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
11607 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
11608 around in a buffer.
11609
11610 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
11611
11612 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
11613 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
11614 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
11615 established system of notation similar to Chess.
11616
11617 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
11618 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
11619 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
11620
11621 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
11622 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
11623 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
11624 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
11625 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
11626 the like.
11627
11628 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
11629 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
11630
11631 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
11632 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
11633 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
11634 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
11635
11636 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
11637
11638 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
11639 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
11640 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
11641 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
11642 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
11643 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
11644 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
11645 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
11646 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
11647 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
11648 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
11649
11650 Platform-specific modes:
11651
11652 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
11653 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
11654 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
11655 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
11656 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
11657 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
11658 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
11659 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
11660 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
11661 \f
11662 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11663
11664 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
11665 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
11666 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
11667 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
11668
11669 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
11670 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
11671 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
11672
11673 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
11674 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
11675 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
11676 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
11677
11678 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
11679 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
11680 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
11681 environment.
11682
11683 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
11684 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
11685 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
11686 current input method for reading this one event.
11687
11688 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
11689 now control whether to output certain characters as
11690 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
11691 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
11692 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
11693 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
11694 \f
11695 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11696
11697 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
11698 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
11699
11700 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
11701 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
11702 always increases point by 1.
11703
11704 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
11705 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
11706
11707 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
11708
11709 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
11710 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
11711 default value changed. For example,
11712
11713 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
11714 :type 'integer
11715 :group 'foo
11716 :version "20.3")
11717
11718 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
11719 :version "20.3")
11720
11721 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
11722 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
11723 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
11724 `:version' in the top level group.
11725
11726 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
11727
11728 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
11729 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
11730
11731 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
11732 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
11733 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
11734 to themselves.
11735
11736 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
11737 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
11738 values whatever.
11739
11740 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
11741 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
11742 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
11743
11744 ** Frame-local variables.
11745
11746 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
11747 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
11748 local bindings for that variable.
11749
11750 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
11751 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
11752 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
11753 parameter name.
11754
11755 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
11756 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
11757 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
11758 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
11759
11760 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
11761 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
11762 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
11763 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
11764
11765 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
11766 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
11767 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
11768 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
11769 See the documentation in sregex.el.
11770
11771 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
11772 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
11773 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
11774 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
11775
11776 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
11777 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
11778
11779 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
11780 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
11781 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
11782
11783 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
11784 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
11785 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
11786 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
11787
11788 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
11789 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
11790 empty input.
11791
11792 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
11793 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
11794 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
11795 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
11796 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
11797
11798 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
11799 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
11800 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
11801 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
11802
11803 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
11804 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
11805 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
11806 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
11807 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
11808
11809 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
11810 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
11811 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
11812 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
11813
11814 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
11815 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
11816 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
11817
11818 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
11819 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
11820 was directed to display this buffer.
11821
11822 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
11823 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
11824 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
11825 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
11826 set-window-configuration.
11827
11828 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
11829 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
11830 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
11831 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
11832
11833 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
11834 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
11835 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
11836
11837 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
11838 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
11839 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
11840
11841 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
11842 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
11843
11844 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
11845 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
11846
11847 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
11848 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
11849 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
11850
11851 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
11852 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
11853 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
11854 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
11855
11856 ** Menu changes
11857
11858 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
11859 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
11860 better supported.
11861
11862 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
11863 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
11864 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
11865 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
11866 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
11867
11868 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
11869
11870 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
11871 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
11872 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
11873 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
11874
11875 The format is:
11876 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
11877 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
11878 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
11879 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
11880 The supported properties include
11881
11882 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11883 item is enabled.
11884 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11885 item should appear in the menu.
11886 :filter FILTER-FN
11887 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
11888 which will be REAL-BINDING.
11889 It should return a binding to use instead.
11890 :keys DESCRIPTION
11891 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
11892 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
11893 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
11894 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
11895 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
11896 keyboard binding.
11897 :key-sequence nil
11898 This means that the command normally has no
11899 keyboard equivalent.
11900 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
11901 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
11902 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
11903 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
11904 value says whether this button is currently selected.
11905
11906 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
11907 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
11908
11909 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
11910
11911 ** New event types
11912
11913 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
11914 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
11915 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
11916 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
11917
11918 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
11919
11920 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11921 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
11922 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
11923 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
11924 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
11925 forward, away from the user.
11926
11927 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11928
11929 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
11930 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
11931 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
11932 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
11933 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
11934
11935 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
11936
11937 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11938 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
11939 that were dragged and dropped.
11940
11941 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11942
11943 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
11944
11945 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
11946 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
11947 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
11948
11949 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
11950 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
11951 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
11952
11953 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
11954 in Emacs 19 and before.
11955
11956 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
11957 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
11958
11959 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
11960 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
11961 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
11962 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
11963
11964 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
11965 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
11966 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
11967 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
11968 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
11969
11970 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
11971 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
11972 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
11973 consistent with the new representation.
11974
11975 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
11976 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
11977 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
11978 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11979
11980 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
11981 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
11982 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
11983
11984 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
11985 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
11986 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11987
11988 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
11989 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
11990 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
11991
11992 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11993 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
11994
11995 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11996 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
11997
11998 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
11999 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
12000 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
12001 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
12002
12003 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
12004 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
12005
12006 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
12007 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
12008 buffer or string being searched.
12009
12010 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
12011 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
12012 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
12013 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
12014 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
12015 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
12016 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
12017
12018 *** Structure of coding system changed.
12019
12020 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
12021 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
12022 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
12023 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
12024 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
12025 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
12026 define-coding-system-alias.
12027
12028 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
12029 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
12030 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
12031 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
12032 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
12033 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
12034 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
12035 `iso-8859-1'.
12036
12037 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
12038 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
12039 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
12040 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
12041
12042 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
12043 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
12044 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
12045 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
12046
12047 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
12048 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
12049 This function requires a user interaction.
12050
12051 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
12052 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
12053 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
12054 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
12055 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
12056 select-safe-coding-system.
12057
12058 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
12059 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
12060 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
12061 was done.
12062
12063 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
12064 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
12065 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
12066
12067 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
12068 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
12069 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
12070 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
12071
12072 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
12073 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
12074 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
12075 converted.
12076
12077 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
12078 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
12079
12080 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
12081 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
12082 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
12083 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
12084 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
12085 range of characters.
12086
12087 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
12088 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
12089
12090 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
12091 in the current buffer at position POS.
12092
12093 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
12094 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
12095 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
12096 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
12097 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
12098 binding input-method-function to nil.
12099
12100 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
12101 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
12102 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
12103 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
12104 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
12105
12106 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
12107 subsequent events of a key sequence.
12108
12109 *** You can customize any language environment by using
12110 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
12111
12112 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
12113 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
12114 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
12115 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
12116 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
12117 \f
12118 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
12119
12120 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
12121 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
12122 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
12123 tree structure.
12124
12125 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
12126 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
12127
12128 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
12129 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
12130 in your .emacs file.)
12131
12132 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
12133 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
12134
12135 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
12136 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
12137
12138 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
12139 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
12140 kills the region.
12141
12142 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
12143 delete the character before point, as usual.
12144
12145 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
12146 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
12147 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
12148
12149 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
12150 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
12151 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
12152 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
12153 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
12154 past.)
12155
12156 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
12157 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
12158 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
12159 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
12160 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
12161
12162 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
12163 and is an alias for it.
12164
12165 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
12166 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
12167
12168 ** Scrolling changes
12169
12170 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
12171 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
12172
12173 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
12174 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
12175 where it started.
12176
12177 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
12178 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
12179 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
12180 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
12181
12182 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
12183 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
12184 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
12185 recenters the window.
12186
12187 ** International character set support (MULE)
12188
12189 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
12190 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
12191 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
12192 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
12193 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
12194 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
12195
12196 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
12197 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
12198 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
12199 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
12200 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
12201
12202 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
12203 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
12204 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
12205 language, to make it possible to type them.
12206
12207 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
12208 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
12209
12210 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
12211 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
12212
12213 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
12214
12215 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
12216
12217 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
12218 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
12219 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
12220 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
12221 characters for their work until they want to change.
12222
12223 *** Input methods
12224
12225 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
12226 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
12227 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
12228 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
12229 support several input methods.
12230
12231 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
12232 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
12233 work.
12234
12235 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
12236 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
12237 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
12238 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
12239 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
12240 letter.
12241
12242 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
12243 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
12244 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
12245 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
12246 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
12247
12248 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
12249 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
12250 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
12251 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
12252
12253 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
12254 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
12255 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
12256 the first guess is wrong.
12257
12258 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
12259 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
12260
12261 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
12262 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
12263 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
12264 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
12265
12266 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
12267 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
12268 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
12269 translate automatically to and from either one.
12270
12271 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
12272
12273 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
12274 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
12275 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
12276 what you want.
12277
12278 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
12279 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
12280 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
12281 multibyte characters in that buffer.
12282
12283 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
12284 character conversion as well.
12285
12286 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
12287
12288 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
12289 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
12290 requires using many fonts.
12291
12292 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
12293 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
12294
12295 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
12296 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
12297 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
12298 you would use a font.
12299
12300 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
12301 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
12302 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
12303
12304 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
12305 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
12306 characters).
12307
12308 *** Defining fontsets.
12309
12310 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
12311 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
12312 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
12313
12314 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
12315 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
12316 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
12317 standard fontset are created automatically.
12318
12319 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
12320 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
12321 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
12322 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
12323 name is `fontset-startup'.
12324
12325 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
12326 The resource value should have this form:
12327 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
12328 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
12329 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
12330 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
12331 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
12332 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
12333 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
12334 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
12335 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
12336
12337 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
12338 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
12339 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
12340
12341 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
12342 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
12343 following resource,
12344 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
12345 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
12346 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
12347 Here is the substitution rule:
12348 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
12349 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
12350 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
12351 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
12352 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
12353
12354 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
12355 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
12356 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
12357
12358 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
12359 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
12360 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
12361 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
12362 fontsets.
12363
12364 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
12365 defaults for a particular choice of language.
12366
12367 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
12368 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
12369 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
12370 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
12371 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
12372 system for new files that you create.
12373
12374 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
12375 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
12376 whole Emacs session.
12377
12378 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
12379 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
12380 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
12381
12382 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
12383 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
12384 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
12385 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
12386 coding systems that Emacs supports.
12387
12388 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
12389 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
12390 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
12391 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
12392 is used for *the immediately following command*.
12393
12394 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
12395 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
12396
12397 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
12398 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
12399
12400 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
12401 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
12402
12403 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
12404 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
12405 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
12406 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
12407 of the file.
12408
12409 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
12410 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
12411 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
12412 translated into that character code.
12413
12414 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
12415 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
12416
12417 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
12418
12419 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
12420 the coding system for keyboard input.
12421
12422 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
12423 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
12424 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
12425
12426 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
12427
12428 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
12429 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
12430 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
12431 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
12432 designed to work with terminals.
12433
12434 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
12435 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
12436 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
12437 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
12438 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
12439 in the corresponding buffer.
12440
12441 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
12442
12443 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
12444 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
12445 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
12446
12447 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
12448 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
12449 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
12450 want to use.
12451
12452 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
12453 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
12454
12455 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
12456 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
12457 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
12458 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
12459
12460 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
12461 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
12462 related information.
12463
12464 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
12465 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
12466 scripts.
12467
12468 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
12469 information about the support for a particular language.
12470 You specify the language as an argument.
12471
12472 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
12473 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
12474 first dash.
12475
12476 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
12477 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
12478 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
12479 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
12480
12481 A alternativnyj (Russian)
12482 B big5 (Chinese)
12483 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
12484 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
12485 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
12486 E euc-japan (Japanese)
12487 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12488 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
12489 K euc-korea (Korean)
12490 R koi8 (Russian)
12491 Q tibetan
12492 S shift_jis (Japanese)
12493 T lao
12494 T tis620 (Thai)
12495 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
12496 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12497 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
12498 v viqr (Vietnamese)
12499 z hz (Chinese)
12500
12501 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
12502 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
12503 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
12504 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
12505
12506 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
12507 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
12508
12509 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
12510 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
12511 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
12512 Rmail files themselves.
12513
12514 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
12515 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
12516
12517 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
12518 for sending mail:
12519
12520 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
12521 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
12522 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
12523 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
12524 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
12525
12526 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
12527 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
12528 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
12529 translations.
12530
12531 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
12532 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
12533 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
12534 without any conversion.
12535
12536 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
12537 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
12538 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
12539 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
12540
12541 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
12542 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
12543
12544 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
12545 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
12546
12547 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
12548 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
12549
12550 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
12551 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
12552 in the buffer before point.
12553
12554 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
12555 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
12556 you are using.
12557
12558 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
12559 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
12560
12561 ** File locking works with NFS now.
12562
12563 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
12564 in the same directory as FILENAME.
12565
12566 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
12567 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
12568 can become a bottleneck.
12569
12570 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
12571 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
12572 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
12573 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
12574 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
12575 so useful that the change is worth while.
12576
12577 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
12578 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
12579 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
12580 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
12581
12582 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
12583 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
12584 show-paren-mode.
12585
12586 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
12587 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
12588 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
12589
12590 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
12591 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
12592 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
12593
12594 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
12595 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
12596 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
12597
12598 ** Changes in View mode.
12599
12600 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
12601 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
12602
12603 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
12604 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
12605
12606 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
12607 previous state.
12608
12609 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
12610 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
12611
12612 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
12613 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
12614 not just the selected window.
12615
12616 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
12617 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
12618 turns View mode on or off.
12619
12620 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
12621 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
12622 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
12623
12624 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
12625 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
12626
12627 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
12628 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
12629 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
12630 which version to compare with.
12631
12632 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
12633 blocks if a match is inside the block.
12634
12635 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
12636 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
12637 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
12638 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
12639
12640 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
12641 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
12642 blocks, all of them or none.
12643
12644 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
12645 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
12646 confirmation first.
12647
12648 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
12649 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
12650 However, the mode will not be changed if
12651 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
12652 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
12653 not suitable for ordinary files, or
12654 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
12655
12656 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
12657
12658 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
12659 these commands do not change the major mode.
12660
12661 ** M-x occur changes.
12662
12663 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
12664 it performs a case-sensitive search.
12665
12666 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
12667 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
12668 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
12669
12670 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
12671 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
12672 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
12673 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
12674 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
12675
12676 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
12677 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
12678 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
12679 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
12680
12681 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12682 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
12683 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
12684
12685 ** Outline mode changes.
12686
12687 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
12688
12689 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
12690
12691 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
12692 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
12693 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
12694 was already active.
12695
12696 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
12697 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
12698 get confused by it.
12699
12700 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
12701 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
12702
12703 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
12704
12705 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
12706 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
12707 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
12708 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
12709
12710 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
12711 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
12712 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
12713
12714 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
12715 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
12716 values.
12717
12718 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
12719 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
12720 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
12721 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
12722
12723 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
12724 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
12725 can be. The default value is 30.
12726
12727 ** Changes in Mail mode.
12728
12729 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
12730 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
12731 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
12732 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
12733 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
12734 behavior.
12735
12736 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
12737 compose-mail-other-frame.
12738
12739 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
12740 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
12741 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
12742 buffer that shows the original message.
12743
12744 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
12745 with separator lines around the contents.
12746
12747 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
12748 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
12749 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
12750 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
12751
12752 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
12753
12754 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
12755 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
12756 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
12757 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
12758
12759 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
12760 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
12761 /etc/passwd.
12762
12763 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
12764 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
12765 /etc/passwd.
12766
12767 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
12768 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
12769 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
12770 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
12771
12772 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
12773 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
12774 be taken to be magic.
12775
12776 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
12777 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
12778 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
12779
12780 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
12781 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
12782
12783 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
12784 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
12785
12786 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
12787
12788 new key dired.el binding old key
12789 ------- ---------------- -------
12790 * c dired-change-marks c
12791 * m dired-mark m
12792 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
12793 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
12794 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
12795 * u dired-unmark u
12796 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
12797 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
12798 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
12799 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
12800 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
12801 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
12802
12803 ** Rmail changes.
12804
12805 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
12806 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
12807 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
12808 each time you run it.
12809
12810 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
12811 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
12812
12813 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
12814 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
12815 means to move in the opposite direction.
12816
12817 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
12818 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
12819
12820 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
12821 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
12822 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
12823 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
12824 for output.
12825
12826 ** Gnus changes.
12827
12828 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
12829
12830 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
12831 Gnus.
12832
12833 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
12834 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
12835
12836 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
12837 article mode line.
12838
12839 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
12840
12841 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
12842
12843 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
12844
12845 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
12846 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
12847 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
12848
12849 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
12850
12851 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
12852
12853 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
12854 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
12855
12856 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
12857 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
12858 used to pick articles.
12859
12860 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
12861 another have been added.
12862
12863 `M-x gnus-change-server'
12864
12865 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
12866 generating lines in buffers.
12867
12868 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
12869 `C-M-_'.
12870
12871 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
12872
12873 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
12874
12875 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
12876
12877 *** Scores can be decayed.
12878
12879 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
12880
12881 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
12882 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
12883
12884 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
12885 the native server.
12886
12887 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
12888
12889 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
12890 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
12891
12892 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
12893
12894 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
12895 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
12896
12897 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
12898 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
12899
12900 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
12901 a group.
12902
12903 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
12904 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
12905
12906 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
12907
12908 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
12909
12910 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
12911
12912 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
12913
12914 Use the `Y c' command.
12915
12916 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
12917
12918 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
12919
12920 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
12921
12922 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
12923 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
12924
12925 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
12926
12927 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
12928
12929 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
12930 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
12931
12932 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
12933
12934 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
12935 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
12936 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
12937 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
12938 this issue.)
12939
12940 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
12941 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
12942 particular news group. This can be done by:
12943
12944 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
12945
12946 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
12947 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
12948 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
12949 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
12950 for reading and posting).
12951
12952 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
12953 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
12954 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
12955 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
12956 there.
12957
12958 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
12959 default. Here are some of these default settings:
12960
12961 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
12962 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
12963 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
12964 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
12965 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
12966
12967 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
12968 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
12969
12970 ** CC mode changes.
12971
12972 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
12973 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
12974 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
12975 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
12976 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
12977 loaded.
12978
12979 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
12980 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
12981 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
12982 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
12983 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
12984 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
12985
12986 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
12987 of the current buffer.
12988
12989 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
12990 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
12991 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
12992
12993 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
12994 style that the Python developers like.
12995
12996 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
12997 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
12998 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
12999
13000 ** VC Changes [new]
13001
13002 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
13003 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
13004 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
13005
13006 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
13007 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
13008 developers.
13009
13010 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
13011 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
13012
13013 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
13014 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
13015 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
13016 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
13017
13018 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
13019 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
13020
13021 ** Calendar changes.
13022
13023 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
13024 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
13025 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
13026 following/previous years.
13027
13028 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
13029 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
13030 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
13031 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
13032 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
13033 supposed attribute of God.
13034
13035 ** ps-print changes
13036
13037 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
13038 layout.
13039
13040 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
13041
13042 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
13043 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
13044 printer system has this behavior, set variable
13045 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
13046
13047 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
13048 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
13049 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
13050
13051 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
13052 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
13053
13054 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
13055 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
13056 printing for your printer.
13057
13058 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
13059 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
13060
13061 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
13062 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
13063
13064 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
13065 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
13066 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
13067 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
13068 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
13069 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
13070 The default value is nil.
13071
13072 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
13073 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
13074
13075 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
13076 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
13077 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
13078 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
13079 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
13080 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
13081 color). The default is 0 ("black").
13082
13083 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
13084 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
13085
13086 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
13087 The default is 0 ("black").
13088
13089 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
13090 The default is 0 ("black").
13091
13092 border-width Specify the border width.
13093 The default is 0.4.
13094
13095 Any other property is ignored.
13096
13097 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
13098 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
13099 documentation).
13100
13101 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
13102 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
13103 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
13104 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
13105 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
13106 controlling headers.
13107
13108 *** Color management (subgroup)
13109
13110 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
13111 color.
13112
13113 *** Face Management (subgroup)
13114
13115 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
13116 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
13117 background should be used. Valid values are:
13118
13119 t always use face background color.
13120 nil never use face background color.
13121 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
13122
13123 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
13124
13125 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
13126 sheet of paper.
13127
13128 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
13129 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
13130
13131 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
13132 each page.
13133
13134 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
13135 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
13136 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
13137
13138 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
13139 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
13140 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
13141
13142 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
13143 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
13144 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
13145
13146 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
13147 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
13148 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
13149
13150 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
13151 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
13152 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
13153
13154 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
13155
13156 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
13157
13158 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
13159 RGB color.
13160
13161 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
13162 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
13163 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
13164
13165 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
13166 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13167 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13168 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13169 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13170 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
13171 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
13172 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
13173 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13174 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13175 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13176 10 + 10 +
13177 11 + 11 +
13178 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13179 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13180 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
13181 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
13182 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
13183 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13184 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13185 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13186 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
13187 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
13188 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
13189 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
13190 22 + 22 +
13191 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13192
13193 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
13194
13195
13196 *** Printer management (subgroup)
13197
13198 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
13199 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
13200 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
13201 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
13202 to "-P".
13203
13204 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
13205 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
13206 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
13207
13208 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
13209 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
13210 do so.
13211
13212 *** Page settings (subgroup)
13213
13214 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
13215 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
13216 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
13217 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
13218 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
13219 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
13220 `setpagedevice'.
13221
13222 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
13223 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
13224 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
13225
13226 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
13227 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
13228 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
13229 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
13230 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
13231 its TO, are ignored.
13232
13233 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
13234 pages. Valid values are:
13235
13236 nil print all pages.
13237
13238 `even-page' print only even pages.
13239
13240 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
13241
13242 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
13243 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
13244 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
13245 print only the even sheet of paper.
13246
13247 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
13248 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
13249 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
13250 only the odd sheet of paper.
13251
13252 Any other value is treated as nil.
13253
13254 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
13255 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
13256 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
13257
13258 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
13259
13260 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
13261 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
13262
13263 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
13264 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
13265 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
13266 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
13267 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
13268 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
13269 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
13270
13271 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
13272 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
13273 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
13274 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
13275 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
13276 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
13277 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
13278
13279 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
13280
13281 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
13282 messages should be sent.
13283
13284 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
13285 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
13286 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
13287
13288 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
13289
13290 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
13291 points for line numbers.
13292
13293 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
13294 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
13295
13296 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
13297 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
13298 to 2, the printing will look like:
13299
13300 1 one line
13301 one line
13302 3 one line
13303 one line
13304 5 one line
13305 one line
13306 ...
13307
13308 Valid values are:
13309
13310 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
13311 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
13312 is used.
13313
13314 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
13315 zebra stripe is to be printed.
13316
13317 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
13318
13319 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
13320 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
13321 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
13322 3, the output will look like:
13323
13324 one line
13325 one line
13326 3 one line
13327 one line
13328 one line
13329 6 one line
13330 one line
13331 one line
13332 9 one line
13333 one line
13334 ...
13335
13336 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
13337 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
13338
13339 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
13340 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
13341 `ps-font-size').
13342
13343 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
13344 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
13345 `ps-font-size').
13346
13347 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
13348
13349 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
13350 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
13351
13352 ** hideshow changes.
13353
13354 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
13355 C++, ; for lisp).
13356
13357 *** Support for java-mode added.
13358
13359 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
13360 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
13361
13362 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
13363 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
13364 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
13365
13366 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
13367 robust and a lot faster.
13368
13369 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
13370
13371 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
13372 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
13373 documentation for more details.
13374
13375 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
13376
13377 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
13378 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
13379 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
13380 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
13381 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
13382
13383 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
13384 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
13385 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
13386 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
13387
13388 ** Font Lock mode
13389
13390 *** Custom support
13391
13392 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
13393 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify
13394 the faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new
13395 custom group font-lock-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in your
13396 ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
13397 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
13398
13399 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
13400
13401 *** Maximum decoration
13402
13403 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
13404 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
13405 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
13406 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
13407 to get the old behavior.
13408
13409 *** New support
13410
13411 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
13412
13413 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
13414 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
13415
13416 *** Configurable support
13417
13418 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
13419 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
13420 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
13421 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
13422 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
13423 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
13424 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
13425
13426 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
13427 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
13428 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
13429
13430 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
13431
13432 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
13433 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
13434 for any mode.
13435
13436 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
13437
13438 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
13439
13440 in your ~/.emacs.
13441
13442 *** New faces
13443
13444 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
13445 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
13446 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
13447 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
13448
13449 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
13450
13451 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
13452 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
13453 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
13454
13455 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
13456
13457 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
13458 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
13459 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
13460 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
13461 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
13462 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
13463 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
13464
13465 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
13466 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
13467 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
13468 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
13469 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
13470 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
13471
13472 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
13473
13474 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
13475 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
13476 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
13477 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
13478
13479 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
13480 settings.
13481
13482 ** Ada mode changes.
13483
13484 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
13485 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
13486 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
13487 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
13488 stubs.
13489
13490 *** There are two new commands:
13491 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
13492 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
13493
13494 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
13495 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
13496 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
13497
13498 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
13499 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
13500 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
13501
13502 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
13503 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
13504 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
13505 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
13506
13507 ** Scheme mode changes.
13508
13509 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
13510 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
13511 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
13512 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
13513 have any effect.
13514
13515 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
13516 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
13517 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
13518 variables as buffer-local variables.
13519
13520 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
13521 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
13522
13523 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
13524
13525 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
13526 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
13527 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
13528 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
13529
13530 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
13531 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
13532 buffer in Emacs.
13533
13534 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
13535 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
13536 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
13537 option takes precedence.
13538
13539 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
13540 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
13541 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
13542
13543 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
13544 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
13545 the current defun.
13546
13547 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
13548 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
13549
13550 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
13551 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
13552 necessary).
13553
13554 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
13555 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
13556 these register values no longer become completely useless.
13557 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
13558 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
13559 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
13560
13561 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
13562 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
13563 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
13564 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
13565
13566 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
13567 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
13568 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
13569 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
13570 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
13571
13572 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
13573 since it applies only to the current frame.
13574
13575 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
13576 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
13577 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
13578
13579 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
13580 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
13581 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
13582 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
13583 instead of just the file you are editing.
13584
13585 ** RefTeX mode
13586
13587 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
13588 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
13589 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
13590 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
13591 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
13592
13593 C-c ( reftex-label
13594 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
13595 knows which kind of label is needed.
13596
13597 C-c ) reftex-reference
13598 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
13599 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
13600
13601 C-c [ reftex-citation
13602 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
13603 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
13604
13605 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
13606 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
13607
13608 C-c = reftex-toc
13609 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
13610 can quickly jump to every section.
13611
13612 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
13613 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
13614 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
13615 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
13616 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
13617
13618 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
13619
13620 *** Info documentation is now available.
13621
13622 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
13623 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
13624
13625 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
13626 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
13627
13628 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
13629 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
13630
13631 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
13632 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
13633 appropriate functions.
13634
13635 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
13636 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
13637
13638 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
13639 been cleaned.
13640
13641 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
13642 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
13643
13644 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
13645 shall be delimited.
13646
13647 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
13648 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
13649 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
13650
13651 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
13652 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
13653 prefixed with `ALT'.
13654
13655 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
13656 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
13657 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
13658 documentation).
13659
13660 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
13661 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
13662 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
13663
13664 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
13665 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
13666
13667 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
13668 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
13669 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
13670
13671 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
13672
13673 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
13674
13675 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
13676 from alien sources.
13677
13678 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
13679 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
13680 crossref entries.
13681
13682 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
13683 region.
13684
13685 *** Added support for imenu.
13686
13687 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
13688 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
13689 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
13690 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
13691
13692 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
13693 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
13694
13695 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
13696
13697 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
13698
13699 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
13700 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
13701 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
13702 as an argument.
13703
13704 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
13705 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
13706
13707 ** browse-url changes
13708
13709 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
13710 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
13711 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
13712 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
13713 customization variables.
13714
13715 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
13716
13717 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
13718 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
13719 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
13720
13721 ** Changes in Ediff
13722
13723 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
13724 pops up the Info file for this command.
13725
13726 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
13727 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
13728 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
13729 directories).
13730
13731 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
13732 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
13733 files in the same directory.
13734
13735 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
13736 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
13737 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
13738
13739 ** Changes in Viper
13740
13741 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
13742 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
13743 instead of vip-.
13744 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
13745 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
13746 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
13747 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
13748 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
13749 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
13750 color when Viper is in insert state.
13751 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
13752 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
13753 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
13754
13755 ** Etags changes.
13756
13757 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
13758 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
13759 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
13760 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
13761 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
13762
13763 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
13764
13765 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
13766 constructs are tagged. Files are recognized by the extension .java.
13767
13768 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
13769 recognized by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
13770 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
13771
13772 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
13773 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
13774 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
13775 methods and protocols.
13776
13777 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognized by the extension
13778 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
13779 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
13780 paragraph name.
13781
13782 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
13783 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
13784 at least M times and as many as N times.
13785
13786 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
13787 in files has changed slightly.
13788
13789 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
13790 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
13791 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
13792 with old time-stamp-format values.
13793
13794 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
13795 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
13796 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
13797 reasons.
13798
13799 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
13800 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
13801 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
13802 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
13803 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
13804 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
13805
13806 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
13807 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
13808 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
13809
13810 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
13811 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
13812 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
13813 recommended now will continue to work then.
13814
13815 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
13816 details.
13817
13818 ** There are some additional major modes:
13819
13820 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
13821 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
13822 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
13823
13824 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
13825 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
13826 into Emacs.
13827
13828 ** New Lisp packages include:
13829
13830 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
13831
13832 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
13833 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
13834
13835 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
13836
13837 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
13838 in shell buffers.
13839
13840 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
13841 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
13842 and `elint-defun'.
13843
13844 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
13845 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
13846 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
13847 strings or comments.
13848
13849 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
13850 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
13851 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
13852 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
13853 at these points.
13854
13855 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
13856 can visit them by short forms of their names.
13857
13858 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
13859 Emacs Lisp function at point.
13860
13861 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
13862
13863 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
13864 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
13865
13866 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
13867
13868 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
13869
13870 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
13871
13872 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
13873 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
13874
13875 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
13876 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
13877 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
13878 original place after inserting the copy.
13879
13880 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
13881 on the buffer.
13882
13883 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
13884 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
13885 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
13886
13887 Enable mouse-drag with:
13888 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
13889 -or-
13890 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
13891
13892 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
13893 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
13894
13895 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
13896 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
13897
13898 *** ogonek
13899
13900 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
13901 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
13902 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
13903 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
13904 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
13905 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
13906 instance) and vice versa.
13907
13908 To use this package load it using
13909 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
13910 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
13911 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
13912 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
13913 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
13914 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
13915
13916 *** Interface to ph.
13917
13918 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
13919
13920 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
13921 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
13922 these servers.
13923
13924 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
13925
13926 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
13927 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
13928 while the real cursor does not move.
13929
13930 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
13931 for visiting your favorite web sites.
13932
13933 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
13934 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
13935
13936 ** movemail change
13937
13938 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
13939 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
13940 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
13941 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
13942
13943 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
13944 \f
13945 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
13946
13947 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
13948
13949 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
13950 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
13951 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
13952 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
13953 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
13954
13955 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
13956 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
13957 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
13958 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
13959 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
13960 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
13961 \f
13962 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
13963
13964 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
13965 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
13966 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
13967 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
13968
13969 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
13970 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
13971
13972 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
13973 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
13974 "win".
13975
13976 ** Basic Lisp changes
13977
13978 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
13979 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
13980
13981 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
13982 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
13983 or by the user.
13984
13985 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
13986
13987 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
13988
13989 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
13990 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
13991
13992 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
13993 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
13994 its argument.
13995
13996 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
13997
13998 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
13999
14000 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
14001
14002 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
14003 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
14004 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
14005 `format' function.
14006
14007 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
14008 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
14009 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
14010
14011 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
14012 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
14013 adding one of these suffixes.
14014
14015 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
14016 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
14017 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
14018
14019 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
14020 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
14021
14022 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
14023
14024 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
14025 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
14026
14027 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
14028 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
14029
14030 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
14031
14032 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
14033 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
14034
14035 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
14036 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
14037 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
14038 works using `save-current-buffer'.
14039
14040 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
14041 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
14042 of the last form.
14043
14044 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
14045 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
14046 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
14047 as the last form.
14048
14049 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
14050 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
14051 matches.
14052
14053 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
14054
14055 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
14056 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
14057 Then it returns that string.
14058
14059 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
14060
14061 (with-output-to-string
14062 (princ "The buffer is ")
14063 (princ (buffer-name)))
14064
14065 returns "The buffer is foo".
14066
14067 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
14068 is non-nil.
14069
14070 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
14071 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
14072 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
14073
14074 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
14075 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
14076
14077 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
14078 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
14079 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
14080 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
14081 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
14082 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
14083
14084 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
14085 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
14086 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
14087 characters".
14088
14089 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
14090 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
14091 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
14092 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
14093 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
14094
14095 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
14096 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
14097 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
14098 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
14099
14100 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
14101 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
14102
14103 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
14104
14105 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
14106 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
14107 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
14108 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
14109 guaranteed.
14110
14111 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
14112 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
14113 character).
14114
14115 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
14116
14117 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
14118 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
14119 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
14120 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
14121 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
14122
14123 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
14124
14125 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
14126 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
14127 more than the number of characters.
14128
14129 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
14130 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
14131 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
14132 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
14133 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
14134 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
14135
14136 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
14137 and returns a string containing those characters.
14138
14139 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
14140 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
14141 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
14142 character, sref signals an error.
14143
14144 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
14145 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
14146 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
14147
14148 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
14149 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
14150 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
14151
14152 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
14153 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
14154 to a vector of the characters in it.
14155
14156 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
14157 of a string. You call it as follows:
14158
14159 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
14160
14161 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
14162 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
14163 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
14164 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
14165 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
14166
14167 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
14168 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
14169
14170 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
14171 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
14172
14173 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
14174 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
14175 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
14176 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
14177
14178 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
14179
14180 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
14181
14182 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
14183 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
14184 are not included in the resulting value.
14185
14186 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
14187 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
14188 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
14189 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
14190
14191 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
14192 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
14193 character extends across that column), then the padding character
14194 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
14195 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
14196 column START-COLUMN.
14197
14198 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
14199 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
14200 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
14201 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
14202 changed text, before the change.
14203
14204 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
14205 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
14206 one character set for each script, not for each language.
14207
14208 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
14209
14210 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
14211
14212 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
14213 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
14214
14215 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
14216 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
14217 which identify the character within that character set.
14218
14219 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
14220 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
14221 opposite of split-char.
14222
14223 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
14224 of all the characters between BEG and END.
14225
14226 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
14227 of all the characters in a string.
14228
14229 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
14230 and specifying coding systems.
14231
14232 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
14233 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
14234 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
14235 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
14236 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
14237 as what to do about code conversion.)
14238
14239 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
14240 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
14241
14242 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
14243 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
14244 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
14245
14246 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
14247 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
14248 to match against a file name.
14249
14250 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
14251 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
14252 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
14253 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
14254 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
14255 specifies the coding system for encoding.
14256
14257 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
14258 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
14259
14260 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
14261 the coding system to use for network sockets.
14262
14263 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
14264 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
14265 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
14266 service names.
14267
14268 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
14269 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
14270 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
14271 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
14272 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
14273 specifies the coding system for encoding.
14274
14275 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
14276 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
14277
14278 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
14279 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
14280 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
14281 start the subprocess.
14282
14283 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
14284 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
14285 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
14286 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
14287 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
14288
14289 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
14290 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
14291 subprocess.
14292
14293 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
14294 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
14295 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
14296 connection permanently or until overridden.
14297
14298 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
14299 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
14300 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
14301 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
14302 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
14303 system for one operation at a time.
14304
14305 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
14306 files, subprocesses or network connections.
14307
14308 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
14309 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
14310 The value is a cons cell,
14311 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
14312 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
14313 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
14314 input to the subprocess.
14315
14316 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
14317 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
14318
14319 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
14320 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
14321 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
14322
14323 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
14324 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
14325 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
14326 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
14327 customization.
14328
14329 Thus, instead of writing
14330
14331 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
14332 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
14333
14334 you would now write this:
14335
14336 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
14337 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
14338 :type 'boolean
14339 :group foo)
14340
14341 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
14342 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
14343 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
14344 for a description of them.
14345
14346 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
14347 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
14348
14349 (defgroup ispell nil
14350 "Spell checking using Ispell."
14351 :group 'processes)
14352
14353 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
14354 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
14355 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
14356 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
14357 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
14358
14359 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
14360 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
14361 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
14362 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
14363 first-level subgroups.
14364
14365 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
14366
14367 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
14368 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
14369
14370 ** easy-mmode
14371
14372 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
14373 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
14374 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
14375 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
14376 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
14377 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
14378
14379 ** Text property changes
14380
14381 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
14382 text property.
14383
14384 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
14385 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
14386 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
14387 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
14388 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
14389
14390 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
14391 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
14392 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
14393 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
14394
14395 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
14396 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
14397 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
14398
14399 ** Changes in invisibility features
14400
14401 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
14402 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
14403 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
14404 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
14405 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
14406 make the overlay visible.
14407
14408 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
14409 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
14410 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
14411 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
14412 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
14413 t when it should hide it.
14414
14415 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
14416
14417 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
14418 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
14419 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
14420 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
14421 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
14422 Here is an example of how to do this:
14423
14424 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
14425 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14426 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
14427 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14428
14429 ...
14430 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
14431
14432 ...
14433 ;; When done with the overlays:
14434 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14435 ;; Or respectively:
14436 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14437
14438 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
14439
14440 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
14441 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
14442 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
14443 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
14444
14445 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
14446 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
14447 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
14448
14449 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
14450 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
14451
14452 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
14453 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
14454
14455 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
14456 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
14457 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
14458
14459 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
14460 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
14461 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
14462 determine the syntax type of the character.
14463
14464 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
14465 of the current buffer.
14466
14467 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
14468 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
14469 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
14470
14471 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
14472 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
14473 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
14474 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
14475 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
14476
14477 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
14478 text property.
14479
14480 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
14481 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
14482 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
14483
14484 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
14485 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
14486 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
14487 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
14488 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
14489
14490 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
14491 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
14492 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
14493
14494 ** Changes in face features
14495
14496 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
14497 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
14498
14499 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
14500 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
14501
14502 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
14503 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
14504
14505 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
14506 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
14507
14508 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
14509 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
14510 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
14511 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
14512 overlay property).
14513
14514 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
14515 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
14516
14517 ** Changes in file-handling functions
14518
14519 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
14520 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
14521 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
14522 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
14523
14524 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
14525 begins with ~.
14526
14527 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
14528 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
14529
14530 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
14531 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
14532
14533 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
14534 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
14535
14536 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
14537 character code conversion as well as other things.
14538
14539 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
14540 (formerly it did not).
14541
14542 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
14543 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
14544
14545 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
14546 instead of constant strings.
14547
14548 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
14549 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
14550 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
14551
14552 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
14553 in the same way as before.
14554
14555 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
14556 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
14557 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
14558
14559 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
14560 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
14561 else, and returns nil.
14562
14563 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
14564 directory cannot be listed.
14565
14566 ** Changes in minibuffer input
14567
14568 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
14569 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
14570 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
14571 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
14572 ways:
14573
14574 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
14575 It is available through the history command M-n.
14576
14577 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
14578 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
14579 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
14580 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
14581 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
14582
14583 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
14584 argument in this way.
14585
14586 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
14587 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
14588 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
14589
14590 ** Echo area features
14591
14592 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
14593 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
14594 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
14595 after the echo area is cleared.
14596
14597 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
14598 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
14599
14600 ** Keyboard input features
14601
14602 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
14603 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
14604
14605 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
14606 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
14607 by keyboard macros.
14608
14609 ** Frame-related changes
14610
14611 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
14612 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
14613 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
14614
14615 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
14616 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
14617 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
14618
14619 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
14620 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
14621 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
14622 in the selected frame.
14623
14624 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
14625 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
14626 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
14627
14628 ** X Windows features
14629
14630 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
14631 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
14632 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
14633
14634 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
14635 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
14636
14637 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
14638 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
14639 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
14640
14641 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
14642 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
14643
14644 ** Subprocess features
14645
14646 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
14647 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
14648 automatically.
14649
14650 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
14651 and returns the output from the command as a string.
14652
14653 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
14654 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
14655
14656 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
14657 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
14658
14659 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
14660 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
14661 goes after the other menu items.
14662
14663 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
14664 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
14665 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
14666 are in use.
14667
14668 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
14669 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
14670
14671 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
14672 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
14673 form.
14674
14675 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
14676 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
14677 but its hook is still run.
14678
14679 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
14680 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
14681
14682 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
14683 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
14684 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
14685
14686 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
14687 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
14688 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
14689 warned.
14690
14691 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
14692 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
14693
14694 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
14695 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
14696 functions like display-time.
14697
14698 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
14699 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
14700
14701 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
14702 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
14703 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
14704
14705 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
14706 if there is an error in compilation.
14707
14708 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
14709 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
14710 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
14711 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
14712
14713 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
14714 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
14715 the *scratch* buffer.
14716
14717 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
14718 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
14719 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
14720 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
14721
14722 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
14723 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
14724 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
14725
14726 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
14727 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
14728 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
14729 and compose-mail-other-frame.
14730
14731 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
14732 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
14733 full name of the specified user will be returned.
14734
14735 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
14736 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
14737 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
14738 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
14739 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
14740 files at all.
14741
14742 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
14743 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
14744 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
14745 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
14746
14747 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
14748 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
14749 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
14750 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
14751
14752 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
14753
14754 ** imenu.el changes.
14755
14756 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
14757 item from menu created by imenu.
14758
14759 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
14760 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
14761 select one of those items.
14762 \f
14763 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
14764
14765 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
14766 Copyright information:
14767
14768 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004,
14769 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14770
14771 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
14772 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
14773 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
14774 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
14775
14776 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
14777 of this document, or of portions of it,
14778 under the above conditions, provided also that they
14779 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
14780 \f
14781 Local variables:
14782 mode: outline
14783 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
14784 end:
14785
14786 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793